webif/var/mongoose/html/jim/ref.html
hummypkg 2e0d49537d update jim documentation
git-svn-id: file:///root/webif/svn/humax/pkg/src/webif/trunk@686 2a923420-c742-0410-a762-8d5b09965624
2012-01-22 19:46:30 +00:00

8071 lines
325 KiB
HTML

<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.1//EN"
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml11/DTD/xhtml11.dtd">
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en">
<head>
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="application/xhtml+xml; charset=UTF-8" />
<meta name="generator" content="AsciiDoc 8.6.5" />
<title>Jim Tcl(n)</title>
<style type="text/css">
/* Shared CSS for AsciiDoc xhtml11 and html5 backends */
/* Default font. */
body {
font-family: Georgia,serif;
}
/* Title font. */
h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6,
div.title, caption.title,
thead, p.table.header,
#toctitle,
#author, #revnumber, #revdate, #revremark,
#footer {
font-family: Arial,Helvetica,sans-serif;
}
body {
margin: 1em 5% 1em 5%;
}
a {
color: blue;
text-decoration: underline;
}
a:visited {
color: fuchsia;
}
em {
font-style: italic;
color: navy;
}
strong {
font-weight: bold;
color: #083194;
}
h1, h2, h3, h4, h5, h6 {
color: #527bbd;
margin-top: 1.2em;
margin-bottom: 0.5em;
line-height: 1.3;
}
h1, h2, h3 {
border-bottom: 2px solid silver;
}
h2 {
padding-top: 0.5em;
}
h3 {
float: left;
}
h3 + * {
clear: left;
}
h5 {
font-size: 1.0em;
}
div.sectionbody {
margin-left: 0;
}
hr {
border: 1px solid silver;
}
p {
margin-top: 0.5em;
margin-bottom: 0.5em;
}
ul, ol, li > p {
margin-top: 0;
}
ul > li { color: #aaa; }
ul > li > * { color: black; }
pre {
padding: 0;
margin: 0;
}
#author {
color: #527bbd;
font-weight: bold;
font-size: 1.1em;
}
#email {
}
#revnumber, #revdate, #revremark {
}
#footer {
font-size: small;
border-top: 2px solid silver;
padding-top: 0.5em;
margin-top: 4.0em;
}
#footer-text {
float: left;
padding-bottom: 0.5em;
}
#footer-badges {
float: right;
padding-bottom: 0.5em;
}
#preamble {
margin-top: 1.5em;
margin-bottom: 1.5em;
}
div.imageblock, div.exampleblock, div.verseblock,
div.quoteblock, div.literalblock, div.listingblock, div.sidebarblock,
div.admonitionblock {
margin-top: 1.0em;
margin-bottom: 1.5em;
}
div.admonitionblock {
margin-top: 2.0em;
margin-bottom: 2.0em;
margin-right: 10%;
color: #606060;
}
div.content { /* Block element content. */
padding: 0;
}
/* Block element titles. */
div.title, caption.title {
color: #527bbd;
font-weight: bold;
text-align: left;
margin-top: 1.0em;
margin-bottom: 0.5em;
}
div.title + * {
margin-top: 0;
}
td div.title:first-child {
margin-top: 0.0em;
}
div.content div.title:first-child {
margin-top: 0.0em;
}
div.content + div.title {
margin-top: 0.0em;
}
div.sidebarblock > div.content {
background: #ffffee;
border: 1px solid #dddddd;
border-left: 4px solid #f0f0f0;
padding: 0.5em;
}
div.listingblock > div.content {
border: 1px solid #dddddd;
border-left: 5px solid #f0f0f0;
background: #f8f8f8;
padding: 0.5em;
}
div.quoteblock, div.verseblock {
padding-left: 1.0em;
margin-left: 1.0em;
margin-right: 10%;
border-left: 5px solid #f0f0f0;
color: #777777;
}
div.quoteblock > div.attribution {
padding-top: 0.5em;
text-align: right;
}
div.verseblock > pre.content {
font-family: inherit;
font-size: inherit;
}
div.verseblock > div.attribution {
padding-top: 0.75em;
text-align: left;
}
/* DEPRECATED: Pre version 8.2.7 verse style literal block. */
div.verseblock + div.attribution {
text-align: left;
}
div.admonitionblock .icon {
vertical-align: top;
font-size: 1.1em;
font-weight: bold;
text-decoration: underline;
color: #527bbd;
padding-right: 0.5em;
}
div.admonitionblock td.content {
padding-left: 0.5em;
border-left: 3px solid #dddddd;
}
div.exampleblock > div.content {
border-left: 3px solid #dddddd;
padding-left: 0.5em;
}
div.imageblock div.content { padding-left: 0; }
span.image img { border-style: none; }
a.image:visited { color: white; }
dl {
margin-top: 0.8em;
margin-bottom: 0.8em;
}
dt {
margin-top: 0.5em;
margin-bottom: 0;
font-style: normal;
color: navy;
}
dd > *:first-child {
margin-top: 0.1em;
}
ul, ol {
list-style-position: outside;
}
ol.arabic {
list-style-type: decimal;
}
ol.loweralpha {
list-style-type: lower-alpha;
}
ol.upperalpha {
list-style-type: upper-alpha;
}
ol.lowerroman {
list-style-type: lower-roman;
}
ol.upperroman {
list-style-type: upper-roman;
}
div.compact ul, div.compact ol,
div.compact p, div.compact p,
div.compact div, div.compact div {
margin-top: 0.1em;
margin-bottom: 0.1em;
}
tfoot {
font-weight: bold;
}
td > div.verse {
white-space: pre;
}
div.hdlist {
margin-top: 0.8em;
margin-bottom: 0.8em;
}
div.hdlist tr {
padding-bottom: 15px;
}
dt.hdlist1.strong, td.hdlist1.strong {
font-weight: bold;
}
td.hdlist1 {
vertical-align: top;
font-style: normal;
padding-right: 0.8em;
color: navy;
}
td.hdlist2 {
vertical-align: top;
}
div.hdlist.compact tr {
margin: 0;
padding-bottom: 0;
}
.comment {
background: yellow;
}
.footnote, .footnoteref {
font-size: 0.8em;
}
span.footnote, span.footnoteref {
vertical-align: super;
}
#footnotes {
margin: 20px 0 20px 0;
padding: 7px 0 0 0;
}
#footnotes div.footnote {
margin: 0 0 5px 0;
}
#footnotes hr {
border: none;
border-top: 1px solid silver;
height: 1px;
text-align: left;
margin-left: 0;
width: 20%;
min-width: 100px;
}
div.colist td {
padding-right: 0.5em;
padding-bottom: 0.3em;
vertical-align: top;
}
div.colist td img {
margin-top: 0.3em;
}
@media print {
#footer-badges { display: none; }
}
#toc {
margin-bottom: 2.5em;
}
#toctitle {
color: #527bbd;
font-size: 1.1em;
font-weight: bold;
margin-top: 1.0em;
margin-bottom: 0.1em;
}
div.toclevel1, div.toclevel2, div.toclevel3, div.toclevel4 {
margin-top: 0;
margin-bottom: 0;
}
div.toclevel2 {
margin-left: 2em;
font-size: 0.9em;
}
div.toclevel3 {
margin-left: 4em;
font-size: 0.9em;
}
div.toclevel4 {
margin-left: 6em;
font-size: 0.9em;
}
span.aqua { color: aqua; }
span.black { color: black; }
span.blue { color: blue; }
span.fuchsia { color: fuchsia; }
span.gray { color: gray; }
span.green { color: green; }
span.lime { color: lime; }
span.maroon { color: maroon; }
span.navy { color: navy; }
span.olive { color: olive; }
span.purple { color: purple; }
span.red { color: red; }
span.silver { color: silver; }
span.teal { color: teal; }
span.white { color: white; }
span.yellow { color: yellow; }
span.aqua-background { background: aqua; }
span.black-background { background: black; }
span.blue-background { background: blue; }
span.fuchsia-background { background: fuchsia; }
span.gray-background { background: gray; }
span.green-background { background: green; }
span.lime-background { background: lime; }
span.maroon-background { background: maroon; }
span.navy-background { background: navy; }
span.olive-background { background: olive; }
span.purple-background { background: purple; }
span.red-background { background: red; }
span.silver-background { background: silver; }
span.teal-background { background: teal; }
span.white-background { background: white; }
span.yellow-background { background: yellow; }
span.big { font-size: 2em; }
span.small { font-size: 0.6em; }
span.underline { text-decoration: underline; }
span.overline { text-decoration: overline; }
span.line-through { text-decoration: line-through; }
/*
* xhtml11 specific
*
* */
tt {
font-family: monospace;
font-size: inherit;
color: navy;
}
div.tableblock {
margin-top: 1.0em;
margin-bottom: 1.5em;
}
div.tableblock > table {
border: 3px solid #527bbd;
}
thead, p.table.header {
font-weight: bold;
color: #527bbd;
}
p.table {
margin-top: 0;
}
/* Because the table frame attribute is overriden by CSS in most browsers. */
div.tableblock > table[frame="void"] {
border-style: none;
}
div.tableblock > table[frame="hsides"] {
border-left-style: none;
border-right-style: none;
}
div.tableblock > table[frame="vsides"] {
border-top-style: none;
border-bottom-style: none;
}
/*
* html5 specific
*
* */
.monospaced {
font-family: monospace;
font-size: inherit;
color: navy;
}
table.tableblock {
margin-top: 1.0em;
margin-bottom: 1.5em;
}
thead, p.tableblock.header {
font-weight: bold;
color: #527bbd;
}
p.tableblock {
margin-top: 0;
}
table.tableblock {
border-width: 3px;
border-spacing: 0px;
border-style: solid;
border-color: #527bbd;
border-collapse: collapse;
}
th.tableblock, td.tableblock {
border-width: 1px;
padding: 4px;
border-style: solid;
border-color: #527bbd;
}
table.tableblock.frame-topbot {
border-left-style: hidden;
border-right-style: hidden;
}
table.tableblock.frame-sides {
border-top-style: hidden;
border-bottom-style: hidden;
}
table.tableblock.frame-none {
border-style: hidden;
}
th.tableblock.halign-left, td.tableblock.halign-left {
text-align: left;
}
th.tableblock.halign-center, td.tableblock.halign-center {
text-align: center;
}
th.tableblock.halign-right, td.tableblock.halign-right {
text-align: right;
}
th.tableblock.valign-top, td.tableblock.valign-top {
vertical-align: top;
}
th.tableblock.valign-middle, td.tableblock.valign-middle {
vertical-align: middle;
}
th.tableblock.valign-bottom, td.tableblock.valign-bottom {
vertical-align: bottom;
}
/* Overrides for manpage documents */
h1 {
padding-top: 0.5em;
padding-bottom: 0.5em;
border-top: 2px solid silver;
border-bottom: 2px solid silver;
}
h2 {
border-style: none;
}
div.sectionbody {
margin-left: 3em;
}
@media print {
div#toc { display: none; }
}
</style>
<script type="text/javascript">
/*<![CDATA[*/
var asciidoc = { // Namespace.
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Table Of Contents generator
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/* Author: Mihai Bazon, September 2002
* http://students.infoiasi.ro/~mishoo
*
* Table Of Content generator
* Version: 0.4
*
* Feel free to use this script under the terms of the GNU General Public
* License, as long as you do not remove or alter this notice.
*/
/* modified by Troy D. Hanson, September 2006. License: GPL */
/* modified by Stuart Rackham, 2006, 2009. License: GPL */
// toclevels = 1..4.
toc: function (toclevels) {
function getText(el) {
var text = "";
for (var i = el.firstChild; i != null; i = i.nextSibling) {
if (i.nodeType == 3 /* Node.TEXT_NODE */) // IE doesn't speak constants.
text += i.data;
else if (i.firstChild != null)
text += getText(i);
}
return text;
}
function TocEntry(el, text, toclevel) {
this.element = el;
this.text = text;
this.toclevel = toclevel;
}
function tocEntries(el, toclevels) {
var result = new Array;
var re = new RegExp('[hH]([2-'+(toclevels+1)+'])');
// Function that scans the DOM tree for header elements (the DOM2
// nodeIterator API would be a better technique but not supported by all
// browsers).
var iterate = function (el) {
for (var i = el.firstChild; i != null; i = i.nextSibling) {
if (i.nodeType == 1 /* Node.ELEMENT_NODE */) {
var mo = re.exec(i.tagName);
if (mo && (i.getAttribute("class") || i.getAttribute("className")) != "float") {
result[result.length] = new TocEntry(i, getText(i), mo[1]-1);
}
iterate(i);
}
}
}
iterate(el);
return result;
}
var toc = document.getElementById("toc");
if (!toc) {
return;
}
// Delete existing TOC entries in case we're reloading the TOC.
var tocEntriesToRemove = [];
var i;
for (i = 0; i < toc.childNodes.length; i++) {
var entry = toc.childNodes[i];
if (entry.nodeName == 'DIV'
&& entry.getAttribute("class")
&& entry.getAttribute("class").match(/^toclevel/))
tocEntriesToRemove.push(entry);
}
for (i = 0; i < tocEntriesToRemove.length; i++) {
toc.removeChild(tocEntriesToRemove[i]);
}
// Rebuild TOC entries.
var entries = tocEntries(document.getElementById("content"), toclevels);
for (var i = 0; i < entries.length; ++i) {
var entry = entries[i];
if (entry.element.id == "")
entry.element.id = "_toc_" + i;
var a = document.createElement("a");
a.href = "#" + entry.element.id;
a.appendChild(document.createTextNode(entry.text));
var div = document.createElement("div");
div.appendChild(a);
div.className = "toclevel" + entry.toclevel;
toc.appendChild(div);
}
if (entries.length == 0)
toc.parentNode.removeChild(toc);
},
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Footnotes generator
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/* Based on footnote generation code from:
* http://www.brandspankingnew.net/archive/2005/07/format_footnote.html
*/
footnotes: function () {
// Delete existing footnote entries in case we're reloading the footnodes.
var i;
var noteholder = document.getElementById("footnotes");
if (!noteholder) {
return;
}
var entriesToRemove = [];
for (i = 0; i < noteholder.childNodes.length; i++) {
var entry = noteholder.childNodes[i];
if (entry.nodeName == 'DIV' && entry.getAttribute("class") == "footnote")
entriesToRemove.push(entry);
}
for (i = 0; i < entriesToRemove.length; i++) {
noteholder.removeChild(entriesToRemove[i]);
}
// Rebuild footnote entries.
var cont = document.getElementById("content");
var spans = cont.getElementsByTagName("span");
var refs = {};
var n = 0;
for (i=0; i<spans.length; i++) {
if (spans[i].className == "footnote") {
n++;
var note = spans[i].getAttribute("data-note");
if (!note) {
// Use [\s\S] in place of . so multi-line matches work.
// Because JavaScript has no s (dotall) regex flag.
note = spans[i].innerHTML.match(/\s*\[([\s\S]*)]\s*/)[1];
spans[i].innerHTML =
"[<a id='_footnoteref_" + n + "' href='#_footnote_" + n +
"' title='View footnote' class='footnote'>" + n + "</a>]";
spans[i].setAttribute("data-note", note);
}
noteholder.innerHTML +=
"<div class='footnote' id='_footnote_" + n + "'>" +
"<a href='#_footnoteref_" + n + "' title='Return to text'>" +
n + "</a>. " + note + "</div>";
var id =spans[i].getAttribute("id");
if (id != null) refs["#"+id] = n;
}
}
if (n == 0)
noteholder.parentNode.removeChild(noteholder);
else {
// Process footnoterefs.
for (i=0; i<spans.length; i++) {
if (spans[i].className == "footnoteref") {
var href = spans[i].getElementsByTagName("a")[0].getAttribute("href");
href = href.match(/#.*/)[0]; // Because IE return full URL.
n = refs[href];
spans[i].innerHTML =
"[<a href='#_footnote_" + n +
"' title='View footnote' class='footnote'>" + n + "</a>]";
}
}
}
},
install: function(toclevels) {
var timerId;
function reinstall() {
asciidoc.footnotes();
if (toclevels) {
asciidoc.toc(toclevels);
}
}
function reinstallAndRemoveTimer() {
clearInterval(timerId);
reinstall();
}
timerId = setInterval(reinstall, 500);
if (document.addEventListener)
document.addEventListener("DOMContentLoaded", reinstallAndRemoveTimer, false);
else
window.onload = reinstallAndRemoveTimer;
}
}
asciidoc.install();
/*]]>*/
</script>
</head>
<body class="manpage">
<div id="header">
<h1>
Jim Tcl(n) Manual Page
</h1>
<h2>NAME</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<p>Jim Tcl v0.73 -
reference manual for the Jim Tcl scripting language
</p>
</div>
</div>
<div id="content">
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_synopsis">SYNOPSIS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>cc &lt;source&gt; -ljim</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>or</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jimsh [&lt;scriptfile&gt;]
jimsh -e '&lt;immediate-script&gt;'
jimsh --version</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="ulist"><div class="title">Quick Index</div><ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#CommandIndex">Command Reference</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#OperatorPrecedence">Operator Precedence</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#BuiltinVariables">Builtin Variables</a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#BackslashSequences">Backslash Sequences</a>
</p>
</li>
</ul></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_introduction">INTRODUCTION</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim Tcl is a small footprint reimplementation of the Tcl scripting language.
The core language engine is compatible with Tcl 8.5+, while implementing
a significant subset of the Tcl 8.6 command set, plus additional features
available only in Jim Tcl.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Some notable differences with Tcl 8.5/8.6 are:</p></div>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Object-based I/O (aio), but with a Tcl-compatibility layer
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
I/O: Support for sockets and pipes including udp, unix domain sockets and IPv6
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Integers are 64bit
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support for references (<a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a>/<a href="#_getref"><strong><tt>getref</tt></strong></a>/<a href="#_setref"><strong><tt>setref</tt></strong></a>) and garbage collection
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Builtin dictionary type (<a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a>) with some limitations compared to Tcl 8.6
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_env"><strong><tt>env</tt></strong></a> command to access environment variables
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Operating system features: <a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.fork</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.wait</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.uptime</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_alarm"><strong><tt>alarm</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_sleep"><strong><tt>sleep</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Much better error reporting. <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>stacktrace</tt> as a replacement for <em>$errorInfo</em>, <em>$errorCode</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support for "static" variables in procedures
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Threads and coroutines are not supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Command and variable traces are not supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Built-in command line editing
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Expression shorthand syntax: <tt>$(&#8230;)</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Modular build allows many features to be omitted or built as dynamic, loadable modules
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Highly suitable for use in an embedded environment
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support for UDP, IPv6, Unix-Domain sockets in addition to TCP sockets
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_recent_changes">RECENT CHANGES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_changes_between_0_72_and_0_73">Changes between 0.72 and 0.73</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Built-in regexp now support non-capturing parentheses: (?:&#8230;)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>replace</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>totitle</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>statics</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <tt>build-jim-ext</tt> for easy separate building of loadable modules (extensions)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a> now works with any command, not just procs
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>alias</tt> to access the target of an alias
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
UTF-8 encoding past the basic multilingual plane (BMP) is supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_tcl_prefix"><strong><tt>tcl::prefix</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_history"><strong><tt>history</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Most extensions are now enabled by default
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for namespaces and the <a href="#_namespace"><strong><tt>namespace</tt></strong></a> command
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_apply"><strong><tt>apply</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_changes_between_0_71_and_0_72">Changes between 0.71 and 0.72</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
procs now allow <em>args</em> and optional parameters in any position
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add Tcl-compatible expr functions, <tt>rand()</tt>, <tt>srand()</tt> and <tt>pow()</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for the <em>-force</em> option to <a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> <tt>delete</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Better diagnostics when <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> fails to load a script with a missing quote or bracket
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
New <tt>tcl_platform(pathSeparator)</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support settings the modification time with <a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> <tt>mtime</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> is now fully supported on win32 (mingw32)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> <tt>join</tt>, <a href="#_pwd"><strong><tt>pwd</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_glob"><strong><tt>glob</tt></strong></a> etc. now work for mingw32
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Line editing is now supported for the win32 console (mingw32)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a> <tt>listen</tt> command
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_changes_between_0_70_and_0_71">Changes between 0.70 and 0.71</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Allow <em>args</em> to be renamed in procs
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <tt>$(&#8230;)</tt> shorthand syntax for expressions
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add automatic reference variables in procs with <tt>&amp;var</tt> syntax
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support <tt>jimsh --version</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Additional variables in <tt>tcl_platform()</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a> procs now push existing commands and <a href="#_upcall"><strong><tt>upcall</tt></strong></a> can call them
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_loop"><strong><tt>loop</tt></strong></a> command (TclX compatible)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a> <tt>buffering</tt> command
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>complete</tt> can now return the missing character
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_binary"><strong><tt>binary</tt></strong></a> <tt>format</tt> and <a href="#_binary"><strong><tt>binary</tt></strong></a> <tt>scan</tt> are now (optionally) supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>byterange</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Built-in regexp now support non-greedy repetition (*?, +?, ??)
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_changes_between_0_63_and_0_70">Changes between 0.63 and 0.70</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
<tt>platform_tcl()</tt> settings are now automatically determined
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add aio <tt>$handle filename</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>channels</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The <em>bio</em> extension is gone. Now <a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a> supports <em>copyto</em>.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_exists"><strong><tt>exists</tt></strong></a> command
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add the pure-Tcl <em>oo</em> extension
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> command now only uses vfork(), not fork()
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Unit test framework is less verbose and more Tcl-compatible
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Optional UTF-8 support
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Optional built-in regexp engine for better Tcl compatibility and UTF-8 support
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Command line editing in interactive mode, e.g. <em>jimsh</em>
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_tcl_introduction">TCL INTRODUCTION</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl stands for <em>tool command language</em> and is pronounced <em>tickle.</em>
It is actually two things: a language and a library.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>First, Tcl is a simple textual language, intended primarily for
issuing commands to interactive programs such as text editors,
debuggers, illustrators, and shells. It has a simple syntax and is also
programmable, so Tcl users can write command procedures to provide more
powerful commands than those in the built-in set.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Second, Tcl is a library package that can be embedded in application
programs. The Tcl library consists of a parser for the Tcl language,
routines to implement the Tcl built-in commands, and procedures that
allow each application to extend Tcl with additional commands specific
to that application. The application program generates Tcl commands and
passes them to the Tcl parser for execution. Commands may be generated
by reading characters from an input source, or by associating command
strings with elements of the application&#8217;s user interface, such as menu
entries, buttons, or keystrokes.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the Tcl library receives commands it parses them into component
fields and executes built-in commands directly. For commands implemented
by the application, Tcl calls back to the application to execute the
commands. In many cases commands will invoke recursive invocations of the
Tcl interpreter by passing in additional strings to execute (procedures,
looping commands, and conditional commands all work in this way).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An application program gains three advantages by using Tcl for its command
language. First, Tcl provides a standard syntax: once users know Tcl,
they will be able to issue commands easily to any Tcl-based application.
Second, Tcl provides programmability. All a Tcl application needs
to do is to implement a few application-specific low-level commands.
Tcl provides many utility commands plus a general programming interface
for building up complex command procedures. By using Tcl, applications
need not re-implement these features.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Third, Tcl can be used as a common language for communicating between
applications. Inter-application communication is not built into the
Tcl core described here, but various add-on libraries, such as the Tk
toolkit, allow applications to issue commands to each other. This makes
it possible for applications to work together in much more powerful ways
than was previously possible.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Fourth, Jim Tcl includes a command processor, <tt>jimsh</tt>, which can be
used to run standalone Tcl scripts, or to run Tcl commands interactively.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This manual page focuses primarily on the Tcl language. It describes
the language syntax and the built-in commands that will be available
in any application based on Tcl. The individual library procedures are
described in more detail in separate manual pages, one per procedure.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_jimsh_command_interpreter">JIMSH COMMAND INTERPRETER</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>A simple, but powerful command processor, <tt>jimsh</tt>, is part of Jim Tcl.
It may be invoked in interactive mode as:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jimsh</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>or to process the Tcl script in a file with:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jimsh filename</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>It may also be invoked to execute an immediate script with:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jimsh -e "script"</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_interactive_mode">Interactive Mode</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Interactive mode reads Tcl commands from standard input, evaluates
those commands and prints the results.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>$ jimsh
Welcome to Jim version 0.73, Copyright (c) 2005-8 Salvatore Sanfilippo
. info version
0.73
. lsort [info commands p*]
package parray pid popen proc puts pwd
. foreach i {a b c} {
{&gt; puts $i
{&gt; }
a
b
c
. bad
invalid command name "bad"
[error] . exit
$</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>jimsh</tt> is configured with line editing (it is by default) and a VT-100-compatible
terminal is detected, Emacs-style line editing commands are available, including:
arrow keys, <tt>^W</tt> to erase a word, <tt>^U</tt> to erase the line, <tt>^R</tt> for reverse incremental search
in history. Additionally, the <tt>h</tt> command may be used to display the command history.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Command line history is automatically saved and loaded from <tt>~/.jim_history</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In interactive mode, <tt>jimsh</tt> automatically runs the script <tt>~/.jimrc</tt> at startup
if it exists.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_interpreters">INTERPRETERS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The central data structure in Tcl is an interpreter (C type <em>Jim_Interp</em>).
An interpreter consists of a set of command bindings, a set of variable
values, and a few other miscellaneous pieces of state. Each Tcl command
is interpreted in the context of a particular interpreter.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Some Tcl-based applications will maintain multiple interpreters
simultaneously, each associated with a different widget or portion of
the application. Interpreters are relatively lightweight structures.
They can be created and deleted quickly, so application programmers should
feel free to use multiple interpreters if that simplifies the application.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_data_types">DATA TYPES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl supports only one type of data: strings. All commands, all arguments
to commands, all command results, and all variable values are strings.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Where commands require numeric arguments or return numeric results,
the arguments and results are passed as strings. Many commands expect
their string arguments to have certain formats, but this interpretation
is up to the individual commands. For example, arguments often contain
Tcl command strings, which may get executed as part of the commands.
The easiest way to understand the Tcl interpreter is to remember that
everything is just an operation on a string. In many cases Tcl constructs
will look similar to more structured constructs from other languages.
However, the Tcl constructs are not structured at all; they are just
strings of characters, and this gives them a different behaviour than
the structures they may look like.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Although the exact interpretation of a Tcl string depends on who is doing
the interpretation, there are three common forms that strings take:
commands, expressions, and lists. The major sections below discuss
these three forms in more detail.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_basic_command_syntax">BASIC COMMAND SYNTAX</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The Tcl language has syntactic similarities to both the Unix shells
and Lisp. However, the interpretation of commands is different
in Tcl than in either of those other two systems.
A Tcl command string consists of one or more commands separated
by newline characters or semi-colons.
Each command consists of a collection of fields separated by
white space (spaces or tabs).
The first field must be the name of a command, and the
additional fields, if any, are arguments that will be passed to
that command. For example, the command:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a 22</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>has three fields: the first, <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a>, is the name of a Tcl command, and
the last two, <em>a</em> and <em>22</em>, will be passed as arguments to
the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command. The command name may refer either to a built-in
Tcl command, an application-specific command bound in with the library
procedure <em>Jim_CreateCommand</em>, or a command procedure defined with the
<a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> built-in command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Arguments are passed literally as text strings. Individual commands may
interpret those strings in any fashion they wish. The <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command,
for example, will treat its first argument as the name of a variable
and its second argument as a string value to assign to that variable.
For other commands arguments may be interpreted as integers, lists,
file names, or Tcl commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Command names should normally be typed completely (e.g. no abbreviations).
However, if the Tcl interpreter cannot locate a command it invokes a
special command named <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> which attempts to find or create the
command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, at many sites <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> will search through library
directories for the desired command and create it as a Tcl procedure if
it is found. The <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> command often provides automatic completion
of abbreviated commands, but usually only for commands that were typed
interactively.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>It&#8217;s probably a bad idea to use abbreviations in command scripts and
other forms that will be re-used over time: changes to the command set
may cause abbreviations to become ambiguous, resulting in scripts that
no longer work.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_comments">COMMENTS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the first non-blank character in a command is <tt>#</tt>, then everything
from the <tt>#</tt> up through the next newline character is treated as
a comment and ignored. When comments are embedded inside nested
commands (e.g. fields enclosed in braces) they must have properly-matched
braces (this is necessary because when Tcl parses the top-level command
it doesn&#8217;t yet know that the nested field will be used as a command so
it cannot process the nested comment character as a comment).</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_grouping_arguments_with_double_quotes">GROUPING ARGUMENTS WITH DOUBLE-QUOTES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally each argument field ends at the next white space, but
double-quotes may be used to create arguments with embedded space.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an argument field begins with a double-quote, then the argument isn&#8217;t
terminated by white space (including newlines) or a semi-colon (see below
for information on semi-colons); instead it ends at the next double-quote
character. The double-quotes are not included in the resulting argument.
For example, the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a "This is a single argument"</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will pass two arguments to <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a>: <em>a</em> and <em>This is a single argument</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Within double-quotes, command substitutions, variable substitutions,
and backslash substitutions still occur, as described below. If the
first character of a command field is not a quote, then quotes receive
no special interpretation in the parsing of that field.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_grouping_arguments_with_braces">GROUPING ARGUMENTS WITH BRACES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Curly braces may also be used for grouping arguments. They are similar
to quotes except for two differences. First, they nest; this makes them
easier to use for complicated arguments like nested Tcl command strings.
Second, the substitutions described below for commands, variables, and
backslashes do <strong>not</strong> occur in arguments enclosed in braces, so braces
can be used to prevent substitutions where they are undesirable.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an argument field begins with a left brace, then the argument ends
at the matching right brace. Tcl will strip off the outermost layer
of braces and pass the information between the braces to the command
without any further modification. For example, in the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a {xyz a {b c d}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command will receive two arguments: <em>a</em>
and <em>xyz a {b c d}</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When braces or quotes are in effect, the matching brace or quote need
not be on the same line as the starting quote or brace; in this case
the newline will be included in the argument field along with any other
characters up to the matching brace or quote. For example, the <a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a>
command takes one argument, which is a command string; <a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a> invokes
the Tcl interpreter to execute the command string. The command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>eval {
set a 22
set b 33
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will assign the value <em>22</em> to <em>a</em> and <em>33</em> to <em>b</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the first character of a command field is not a left
brace, then neither left nor right
braces in the field will be treated specially (except as part of
variable substitution; see below).</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_command_substitution_with_brackets">COMMAND SUBSTITUTION WITH BRACKETS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an open bracket occurs in a field of a command, then command
substitution occurs (except for fields enclosed in braces). All of the
text up to the matching close bracket is treated as a Tcl command and
executed immediately. Then the result of that command is substituted
for the bracketed text. For example, consider the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a [set b]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command has only a single argument, it is the name of a
variable and <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> returns the contents of that variable. In this case,
if variable <em>b</em> has the value <em>foo</em>, then the command above is equivalent
to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a foo</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Brackets can be used in more complex ways. For example, if the variable
<em>b</em> has the value <em>foo</em> and the variable <em>c</em> has the value <em>gorp</em>,
then the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyz[set b].[set c]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyzfoo.gorp</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>A bracketed command may contain multiple commands separated by newlines
or semi-colons in the usual fashion. In this case the value of the last
command is used for substitution. For example, the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a x[set b 22
expr $b+2]x</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a x24x</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a field is enclosed in braces then the brackets and the characters
between them are not interpreted specially; they are passed through to
the argument verbatim.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_variable_substitution_with">VARIABLE SUBSTITUTION WITH $</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The dollar sign (<tt>$</tt>) may be used as a special shorthand form for
substituting variable values. If <tt>$</tt> appears in an argument that isn&#8217;t
enclosed in braces then variable substitution will occur. The characters
after the <tt>$</tt>, up to the first character that isn&#8217;t a number, letter,
or underscore, are taken as a variable name and the string value of that
variable is substituted for the name.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, if variable <em>foo</em> has the value <em>test</em>, then the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a $foo.c</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a test.c</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>There are two special forms for variable substitution. If the next
character after the name of the variable is an open parenthesis, then
the variable is assumed to be an array name, and all of the characters
between the open parenthesis and the next close parenthesis are taken as
an index into the array. Command substitutions and variable substitutions
are performed on the information between the parentheses before it is
used as an index.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, if the variable <em>x</em> is an array with one element named
<em>first</em> and value <em>87</em> and another element named <em>14</em> and value <em>more</em>,
then the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyz$x(first)zyx</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyz87zyx</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the variable <em>index</em> has the value <em>14</em>, then the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyz$x($index)zyx</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a xyzmorezyx</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For more information on arrays, see VARIABLES AND ARRAYS below.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The second special form for variables occurs when the dollar sign is
followed by an open curly brace. In this case the variable name consists
of all the characters up to the next curly brace.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Array references are not possible in this form: the name between braces
is assumed to refer to a scalar variable. For example, if variable
<em>foo</em> has the value <em>test</em>, then the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a abc${foo}bar</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is equivalent to the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a abctestbar</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Variable substitution does not occur in arguments that are enclosed in
braces: the dollar sign and variable name are passed through to the
argument verbatim.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The dollar sign abbreviation is simply a shorthand form. <tt>$a</tt> is
completely equivalent to <tt>[set a]</tt>; it is provided as a convenience
to reduce typing.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_separating_commands_with_semi_colons">SEPARATING COMMANDS WITH SEMI-COLONS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally, each command occupies one line (the command is terminated by a
newline character). However, semi-colon (<tt>;</tt>) is treated as a command
separator character; multiple commands may be placed on one line by
separating them with a semi-colon. Semi-colons are not treated as
command separators if they appear within curly braces or double-quotes.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_backslash_substitution">BACKSLASH SUBSTITUTION</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Backslashes may be used to insert non-printing characters into command
fields and also to insert special characters like braces and brackets
into fields without them being interpreted specially as described above.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The backslash sequences understood by the Tcl interpreter are
listed below. In each case, the backslash
sequence is replaced by the given character:</p></div>
<div class="dlist" id="BackslashSequences"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\b</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Backspace (0x8)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\f</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Form feed (0xc)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\n</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Newline (0xa)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\r</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Carriage-return (0xd).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\t</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Tab (0x9).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\v</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Vertical tab (0xb).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\{</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Left brace ({).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\}</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Right brace (}).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\[</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open bracket ([).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\]</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Close bracket (]).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\$</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Dollar sign ($).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\&lt;space&gt;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Space ( ): doesn&#8217;t terminate argument.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Semi-colon: doesn&#8217;t terminate command.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\"</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Double-quote.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\&lt;newline&gt;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Nothing: this joins two lines together
into a single line. This backslash feature is unique in that
it will be applied even when the sequence occurs within braces.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\\</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Backslash (<em>\</em>).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\ddd</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The digits <tt><em>ddd</em></tt> (one, two, or three of them) give the octal value of
the character. Note that Jim supports null characters in strings.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\unnnn</tt>
</dt>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\u{nnn}</tt>
</dt>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\Unnnnnnnn</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The UTF-8 encoding of the unicode codepoint represented by the hex digits, <tt><em>nnnn</em></tt>, is inserted.
The <em>u</em> form allows for one to four hex digits.
The <em>U</em> form allows for one to eight hex digits.
The <em>u{nnn}</em> form allows for one to eight hex digits, but makes it easier to insert
characters UTF-8 characters which are followed by a hex digit.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, in the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a \{x\[\ yz\141</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>the second argument to <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> will be <tt>{x[ yza</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a backslash is followed by something other than one of the options
described above, then the backslash is transmitted to the argument
field without any special processing, and the Tcl scanner continues
normal processing with the next character. For example, in the
command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set \*a \\\{foo</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The first argument to <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> will be <tt>\*a</tt> and the second
argument will be <tt>\{foo</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an argument is enclosed in braces, then backslash sequences inside
the argument are parsed but no substitution occurs (except for
backslash-newline): the backslash
sequence is passed through to the argument as is, without making
any special interpretation of the characters in the backslash sequence.
In particular, backslashed braces are not counted in locating the
matching right brace that terminates the argument.
For example, in the
command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a {\{abc}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>the second argument to <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> will be <tt>\{abc</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This backslash mechanism is not sufficient to generate absolutely
any argument structure; it only covers the
most common cases. To produce particularly complicated arguments
it is probably easiest to use the <a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a> command along with
command substitution.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_string_and_list_index_specifications">STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Many string and list commands take one or more <em>index</em> parameters which
specify a position in the string relative to the start or end of the string/list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The index may be one of the following forms:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>integer</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A simple integer, where <em>0</em> refers to the first element of the string
or list.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>integer+integer</tt> or
</dt>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>integer-integer</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The sum or difference of the two integers. e.g. <tt>2+3</tt> refers to the 5th element.
This is useful when used with (e.g.) <tt>$i+1</tt> rather than the more verbose
<tt>[expr {$i+1}]</tt>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>end</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The last element of the string or list.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>end-integer</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The <em>nth-from-last</em> element of the string or list.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_command_summary">COMMAND SUMMARY</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
A command is just a string.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Within a string commands are separated by newlines or semi-colons
(unless the newline or semi-colon is within braces or brackets
or is backslashed).
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
A command consists of fields. The first field is the name of the command.
The other fields are strings that are passed to that command as arguments.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Fields are normally separated by white space.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Double-quotes allow white space and semi-colons to appear within
a single argument.
Command substitution, variable substitution, and backslash substitution
still occur inside quotes.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Braces defer interpretation of special characters.
If a field begins with a left brace, then it consists of everything
between the left brace and the matching right brace. The
braces themselves are not included in the argument.
No further processing is done on the information between the braces
except that backslash-newline sequences are eliminated.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
If a field doesn&#8217;t begin with a brace then backslash,
variable, and command substitution are done on the field. Only a
single level of processing is done: the results of one substitution
are not scanned again for further substitutions or any other
special treatment. Substitution can
occur on any field of a command, including the command name
as well as the arguments.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
If the first non-blank character of a command is a <tt>#</tt>, everything
from the <tt>#</tt> up through the next newline is treated as a comment
and ignored.
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_expressions">EXPRESSIONS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The second major interpretation applied to strings in Tcl is
as expressions. Several commands, such as <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a>,
and <a href="#_if"><strong><tt>if</tt></strong></a>, treat one or more of their arguments as expressions
and call the Tcl expression processors (<em>Jim_ExprLong</em>,
<em>Jim_ExprBoolean</em>, etc.) to evaluate them.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The operators permitted in Tcl expressions are a subset of
the operators permitted in C expressions, and they have the
same meaning and precedence as the corresponding C operators.
Expressions almost always yield numeric results
(integer or floating-point values).
For example, the expression</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>8.2 + 6</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>evaluates to 14.2.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl expressions differ from C expressions in the way that
operands are specified, and in that Tcl expressions support
non-numeric operands and string comparisons.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>A Tcl expression consists of a combination of operands, operators,
and parentheses.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>White space may be used between the operands and operators and
parentheses; it is ignored by the expression processor.
Where possible, operands are interpreted as integer values.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Integer values may be specified in decimal (the normal case), in octal (if the
first character of the operand is <em>0</em>), or in hexadecimal (if the first
two characters of the operand are <em>0x</em>).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an operand does not have one of the integer formats given
above, then it is treated as a floating-point number if that is
possible. Floating-point numbers may be specified in any of the
ways accepted by an ANSI-compliant C compiler (except that the
<em>f</em>, <em>F</em>, <em>l</em>, and <em>L</em> suffixes will not be permitted in
most installations). For example, all of the
following are valid floating-point numbers: 2.1, 3., 6e4, 7.91e+16.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no numeric interpretation is possible, then an operand is left
as a string (and only a limited set of operators may be applied to
it).</p></div>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Operands may be specified in any of the following ways:
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
As a numeric value, either integer or floating-point.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
As a Tcl variable, using standard <em>$</em> notation.
The variable&#8217;s value will be used as the operand.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
As a string enclosed in double-quotes.
The expression parser will perform backslash, variable, and
command substitutions on the information between the quotes,
and use the resulting value as the operand
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
As a string enclosed in braces.
The characters between the open brace and matching close brace
will be used as the operand without any substitutions.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
As a Tcl command enclosed in brackets.
The command will be executed and its result will be used as
the operand.
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Where substitutions occur above (e.g. inside quoted strings), they
are performed by the expression processor.
However, an additional layer of substitution may already have
been performed by the command parser before the expression
processor was called.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>As discussed below, it is usually best to enclose expressions
in braces to prevent the command parser from performing substitutions
on the contents.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For some examples of simple expressions, suppose the variable <em>a</em> has
the value 3 and the variable <em>b</em> has the value 6. Then the expression
on the left side of each of the lines below will evaluate to the value
on the right side of the line:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>$a + 3.1 6.1
2 + "$a.$b" 5.6
4*[llength "6 2"] 8
{word one} &lt; "word $a" 0</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The valid operators are listed below, grouped in decreasing order
of precedence:</p></div>
<div class="dlist" id="OperatorPrecedence"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>int() double() round() abs(), rand(), srand()</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Unary functions (except rand() which takes no arguments)
</p>
<div class="ulist"><ul>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>int()</em></tt> converts the numeric argument to an integer by truncating down.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>double()</em></tt> converts the numeric argument to floating point.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>round()</em></tt> converts the numeric argument to the closest integer value.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>abs()</em></tt> takes the absolute value of the numeric argument.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>rand()</em></tt> takes the absolute value of the numeric argument.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>rand()</em></tt> returns a pseudo-random floating-point value in the range (0,1).
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt><em>srand()</em></tt> takes an integer argument to (re)seed the random number generator. Returns the first random number from that seed.
</p>
</li>
</ul></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>sin() cos() tan() asin() acos() atan() sinh() cosh() tanh() ceil() floor() exp() log() log10() sqrt()</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Unary math functions.
If Jim is compiled with math support, these functions are available.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>- + ~ !</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Unary minus, unary plus, bit-wise NOT, logical NOT. None of these operands
may be applied to string operands, and bit-wise NOT may be
applied only to integers.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>** pow(x,y)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Power. e.g. <em>x<sup>y</sup></em>. If Jim is compiled with math support, supports doubles and
integers. Otherwise supports integers only. (Note that the math-function form
has the same highest precedence)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>* / %</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Multiply, divide, remainder. None of these operands may be
applied to string operands, and remainder may be applied only
to integers.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>+ -</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Add and subtract. Valid for any numeric operands.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&lt;&lt; &gt;&gt; &lt;&lt;&lt; &gt;&gt;&gt;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Left and right shift, left and right rotate. Valid for integer operands only.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&lt; &gt; &lt;= &gt;=</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Boolean less, greater, less than or equal, and greater than or equal.
Each operator produces 1 if the condition is true, 0 otherwise.
These operators may be applied to strings as well as numeric operands,
in which case string comparison is used.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>== !=</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Boolean equal and not equal. Each operator produces a zero/one result.
Valid for all operand types. <strong>Note</strong> that values will be converted to integers
if possible, then floating point types, and finally strings will be compared.
It is recommended that <em>eq</em> and <em>ne</em> should be used for string comparison.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>eq ne</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
String equal and not equal. Uses the string value directly without
attempting to convert to a number first.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>in ni</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
String in list and not in list. For <em>in</em>, result is 1 if the left operand (as a string)
is contained in the right operand (as a list), or 0 otherwise. The result for
<tt>{$a ni $list}</tt> is equivalent to <tt>{!($a in $list)}</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&amp;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Bit-wise AND. Valid for integer operands only.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>|</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Bit-wise OR. Valid for integer operands only.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>^</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Bit-wise exclusive OR. Valid for integer operands only.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&amp;&amp;</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Logical AND. Produces a 1 result if both operands are non-zero, 0 otherwise.
Valid for numeric operands only (integers or floating-point).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>||</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Logical OR. Produces a 0 result if both operands are zero, 1 otherwise.
Valid for numeric operands only (integers or floating-point).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>x ? y : z</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If-then-else, as in C. If <tt><em>x</em></tt>
evaluates to non-zero, then the result is the value of <tt><em>y</em></tt>.
Otherwise the result is the value of <tt><em>z</em></tt>.
The <tt><em>x</em></tt> operand must have a numeric value, while <tt><em>y</em></tt> and <tt><em>z</em></tt> can
be of any type.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the C manual for more details on the results
produced by each operator.
All of the binary operators group left-to-right within the same
precedence level. For example, the expression</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>4*2 &lt; 7</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>evaluates to 0.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt>&amp;&amp;</tt>, <tt>||</tt>, and <tt>?:</tt> operators have <em>lazy evaluation</em>, just as
in C, which means that operands are not evaluated if they are not
needed to determine the outcome. For example, in</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>$v ? [a] : [b]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>only one of <tt>[a]</tt> or <tt>[b]</tt> will actually be evaluated,
depending on the value of <tt>$v</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>All internal computations involving integers are done with the C
type <em>long long</em> if available, or <em>long</em> otherwise, and all internal
computations involving floating-point are done with the C type
<em>double</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When converting a string to floating-point, exponent overflow is
detected and results in a Tcl error.
For conversion to integer from string, detection of overflow depends
on the behaviour of some routines in the local C library, so it should
be regarded as unreliable.
In any case, overflow and underflow are generally not detected
reliably for intermediate results.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Conversion among internal representations for integer, floating-point,
and string operands is done automatically as needed.
For arithmetic computations, integers are used until some
floating-point number is introduced, after which floating-point is used.
For example,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>5 / 4</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>yields the result 1, while</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>5 / 4.0
5 / ( [string length "abcd"] + 0.0 )</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>both yield the result 1.25.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>String values may be used as operands of the comparison operators,
although the expression evaluator tries to do comparisons as integer
or floating-point when it can.
If one of the operands of a comparison is a string and the other
has a numeric value, the numeric operand is converted back to
a string using the C <em>sprintf</em> format specifier
<em>%d</em> for integers and <em>%g</em> for floating-point values.
For example, the expressions</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>"0x03" &gt; "2"
"0y" &lt; "0x12"</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>both evaluate to 1. The first comparison is done using integer
comparison, and the second is done using string comparison after
the second operand is converted to the string <em>18</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In general it is safest to enclose an expression in braces when
entering it in a command: otherwise, if the expression contains
any white space then the Tcl interpreter will split it
among several arguments. For example, the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>expr $a + $b</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>results in three arguments being passed to <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a>: <tt>$a</tt>,
+, and <tt>$b</tt>. In addition, if the expression isn&#8217;t in braces
then the Tcl interpreter will perform variable and command substitution
immediately (it will happen in the command parser rather than in
the expression parser). In many cases the expression is being
passed to a command that will evaluate the expression later (or
even many times if, for example, the expression is to be used to
decide when to exit a loop). Usually the desired goal is to re-do
the variable or command substitutions each time the expression is
evaluated, rather than once and for all at the beginning. For example,
the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>for {set i 1} $i&lt;=10 {incr i} {...} ** WRONG **</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is probably intended to iterate over all values of <tt>i</tt> from 1 to 10.
After each iteration of the body of the loop, <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> will pass
its second argument to the expression evaluator to see whether or not
to continue processing. Unfortunately, in this case the value of <tt>i</tt>
in the second argument will be substituted once and for all when the
<a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> command is parsed. If <tt>i</tt> was 0 before the <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a>
command was invoked then the second argument of <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> will be <tt>0&lt;=10</tt>
which will always evaluate to 1, even though <tt>i</tt> eventually
becomes greater than 10. In the above case the loop will never
terminate. Instead, the expression should be placed in braces:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>for {set i 1} {$i&lt;=10} {incr i} {...} ** RIGHT **</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This causes the substitution of <em>i</em>
to be delayed; it will be re-done each time the expression is
evaluated, which is the desired result.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_lists">LISTS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The third major way that strings are interpreted in Tcl is as lists.
A list is just a string with a list-like structure
consisting of fields separated by white space. For example, the
string</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>Al Sue Anne John</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is a list with four elements or fields.
Lists have the same basic structure as command strings, except
that a newline character in a list is treated as a field separator
just like space or tab. Conventions for braces and quotes
and backslashes are the same for lists as for commands. For example,
the string</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>a b\ c {d e {f g h}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is a list with three elements: <tt>a</tt>, <tt>b c</tt>, and <tt>d e {f g h}</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Whenever an element is extracted from a list, the same rules about
braces and quotes and backslashes are applied as for commands. Thus in
the example above when the third element is extracted from the list,
the result is</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>d e {f g h}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>(when the field was extracted, all that happened was to strip off
the outermost layer of braces). Command substitution and
variable substitution are never
made on a list (at least, not by the list-processing commands; the
list can always be passed to the Tcl interpreter for evaluation).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The Tcl commands <a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lappend"><strong><tt>lappend</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_linsert"><strong><tt>linsert</tt></strong></a>,
<a href="#_list"><strong><tt>list</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_llength"><strong><tt>llength</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lrange"><strong><tt>lrange</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lreplace"><strong><tt>lreplace</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a>, and <a href="#_lsort"><strong><tt>lsort</tt></strong></a> allow
you to build lists, extract elements from them, search them, and perform
other list-related functions.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Advanced list commands include <a href="#_lrepeat"><strong><tt>lrepeat</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lreverse"><strong><tt>lreverse</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lmap"><strong><tt>lmap</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lassign"><strong><tt>lassign</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_list_expansion">LIST EXPANSION</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>A new addition to Tcl 8.5 is the ability to expand a list into separate
arguments. Support for this feature is also available in Jim.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Consider the following attempt to exec a list:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set cmd {ls -l}
exec $cmd</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This will attempt to exec the a command named "ls -l", which will clearly not
work. Typically eval and concat are required to solve this problem, however
it can be solved much more easily with <tt>{*}</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>exec {*}$cmd</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This will expand the following argument into individual elements and then evaluate
the resulting command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that the official Tcl syntax is <tt>{*}</tt>, however <tt>{expand}</tt> is retained
for backward compatibility with experimental versions of this feature.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_regular_expressions">REGULAR EXPRESSIONS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl provides two commands that support string matching using regular
expressions, <a href="#_regexp"><strong><tt>regexp</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_regsub"><strong><tt>regsub</tt></strong></a>, as well as <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-regexp</tt> and
<a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-regexp</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Regular expressions may be implemented one of two ways. Either using the system&#8217;s C library
POSIX regular expression support, or using the built-in regular expression engine.
The differences between these are described below.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>NOTE</strong> Tcl 7.x and 8.x use perl-style Advanced Regular Expressions (<tt>ARE</tt>).</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_posix_regular_expressions">POSIX Regular Expressions</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the system supports POSIX regular expressions, and UTF-8 support is not enabled,
this support will be used by default. The type of regular expressions supported are
Extended Regular Expressions (<tt>ERE</tt>) rather than Basic Regular Expressions (<tt>BRE</tt>).
See REG_EXTENDED in the documentation.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Using the system-supported POSIX regular expressions will typically
make for the smallest code size, but some features such as UTF-8
and <tt>\w</tt>, <tt>\d</tt>, <tt>\s</tt> are not supported.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See regex(3) and regex(7) for full details.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_jim_built_in_regular_expressions">Jim built-in Regular Expressions</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The Jim built-in regulare expression engine may be selected with <tt>./configure --with-jim-regexp</tt>
or it will be selected automatically if UTF-8 support is enabled.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This engine supports UTF-8 as well as some <tt>ARE</tt> features. The differences with both Tcl 7.x/8.x
and POSIX are highlighted below.</p></div>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
UTF-8 strings and patterns are both supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Supported character classes: <tt>[:alnum:]</tt>, <tt>[:digit:]</tt> and <tt>[:space:]</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Supported shorthand character classes: <tt>\w</tt> = <tt>[:alnum:]</tt>, <tt>\d</tt> = <tt>[:digit:],</tt> <tt>\s</tt> = <tt>[:space:]</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Character classes apply to ASCII characters only
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Supported constraint escapes: <tt>\m</tt> = <tt>\&lt;</tt> = start of word, <tt>\M</tt> = <tt>\&gt;</tt> = end of word
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Backslash escapes may be used within regular expressions, such as <tt>\n</tt> = newline, <tt>\uNNNN</tt> = unicode
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support for the <tt>?</tt> non-greedy quantifier. e.g. <tt>*?</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Support for non-capuring parentheses <tt>(?:&#8230;)</tt>
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_command_results">COMMAND RESULTS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Each command produces two results: a code and a string. The
code indicates whether the command completed successfully or not,
and the string gives additional information. The valid codes are
defined in jim.h, and are:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_OK(0)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This is the normal return code, and indicates that the command completed
successfully. The string gives the command&#8217;s return value.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_ERR(1)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that an error occurred; the string gives a message describing
the error.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_RETURN(2)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that the <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> command has been invoked, and that the
current procedure (or top-level command or <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command)
should return immediately. The
string gives the return value for the procedure or command.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_BREAK(3)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that the <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a> command has been invoked, so the
innermost loop should abort immediately. The string should always
be empty.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_CONTINUE(4)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that the <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a> command has been invoked, so the
innermost loop should go on to the next iteration. The string
should always be empty.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_SIGNAL(5)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that a signal was caught while executing a commands.
The string contains the name of the signal caught.
See the <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> commands.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>JIM_EXIT(6)</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Indicates that the command called the <a href="#_exit"><strong><tt>exit</tt></strong></a> command.
The string contains the exit code.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl programmers do not normally need to think about return codes,
since <tt>JIM_OK</tt> is almost always returned. If anything else is returned
by a command, then the Tcl interpreter immediately stops processing
commands and returns to its caller. If there are several nested
invocations of the Tcl interpreter in progress, then each nested
command will usually return the error to its caller, until eventually
the error is reported to the top-level application code. The
application will then display the error message for the user.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In a few cases, some commands will handle certain <a href="#_error"><strong><tt>error</tt></strong></a> conditions
themselves and not return them upwards. For example, the <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a>
command checks for the <tt>JIM_BREAK</tt> code; if it occurs, then <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a>
stops executing the body of the loop and returns <tt>JIM_OK</tt> to its
caller. The <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> command also handles <tt>JIM_CONTINUE</tt> codes and the
procedure interpreter handles <tt>JIM_RETURN</tt> codes. The <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>
command allows Tcl programs to catch errors and handle them without
aborting command interpretation any further.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>returncodes</tt> command may be used to programmatically map between
return codes and names.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_procedures">PROCEDURES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl allows you to extend the command interface by defining
procedures. A Tcl procedure can be invoked just like any other Tcl
command (it has a name and it receives one or more arguments).
The only difference is that its body isn&#8217;t a piece of C code linked
into the program; it is a string containing one or more other
Tcl commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> command is used to create a new Tcl command procedure:</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>proc</strong> <em>name arglist ?statics? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The new command is named <tt><em>name</em></tt>, and it replaces any existing command
there may have been by that name. Whenever the new command is
invoked, the contents of <tt><em>body</em></tt> will be executed by the Tcl
interpreter.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>arglist</em></tt> specifies the formal arguments to the procedure.
It consists of a list, possibly empty, of the following
argument specifiers:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>name</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Required Argument - A simple argument name.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>name default</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Optional Argument - A two-element list consisting of the
argument name, followed by the default value, which will
be used if the corresponding argument is not supplied.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&amp;name</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Reference Argument - The caller is expected to pass the name of
an existing variable. An implicit <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> <tt>1 'origname' 'name'</tt> is done
to make the variable available in the proc scope.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>args</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Variable Argument - The special name <tt><em>args</em></tt>, which is
assigned all remaining arguments (including none) as a list. The
variable argument may only be specified once. Note that
the syntax <tt>args newname</tt> may be used to retain the special
behaviour of <tt><em>args</em></tt> with a different local name. In this case,
the variable is named <tt><em>newname</em></tt> rather than <tt><em>args</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When the command is invoked, a local variable will be created for each of
the formal arguments to the procedure; its value will be the value
of corresponding argument in the invoking command or the argument&#8217;s
default value.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Arguments with default values need not be specified in a procedure
invocation. However, there must be enough actual arguments for all
required arguments, and there must not be any extra actual arguments
(unless the Variable Argument is specified).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Actual arguments are assigned to formal arguments as in left-to-right
order with the following precedence.</p></div>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Required Arguments (including Reference Arguments)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Optional Arguments
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Variable Argument
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following example illustrates precedence. Assume a procedure declaration:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>proc p {{a A} args b {c C} d} {...}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This procedure requires at least two arguments, but can accept an unlimited number.
The following table shows how various numbers of arguments are assigned.
Values marked as <tt>-</tt> are assigned the default value.</p></div>
<div class="tableblock">
<table rules="all"
width="40%"
frame="hsides"
cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
<col width="16%" />
<col width="16%" />
<col width="16%" />
<col width="16%" />
<col width="16%" />
<col width="16%" />
<thead>
<tr>
<th align="left" valign="top">Number of arguments</th>
<th align="left" valign="top">a</th>
<th align="left" valign="top">args</th>
<th align="left" valign="top">b</th>
<th align="left" valign="top">c</th>
<th align="left" valign="top">d</th>
</tr>
</thead>
<tbody>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">1</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2</p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">3</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">1</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">3</p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">4</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">1</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">-</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">3</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">4</p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">5</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">1</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">3</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">4</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">5</p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">6</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">1</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">2,3</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">4</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">5</p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table">6</p></td>
</tr>
</tbody>
</table>
</div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When <tt><em>body</em></tt> is being executed, variable names normally refer to local
variables, which are created automatically when referenced and deleted
when the procedure returns. One local variable is automatically created
for each of the procedure&#8217;s arguments. Global variables can be
accessed by invoking the <a href="#_global"><strong><tt>global</tt></strong></a> command or via the <tt>::</tt> prefix.</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_new_in_jim">New in Jim</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In addition to procedure arguments, Jim procedures may declare static variables.
These variables scoped to the procedure and initialised at procedure definition.
Either from the static variable definition, or from the enclosing scope.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Consider the following example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; set a 1
jim&gt; proc a {} {a {b 2}} {
set c 1
puts "$a $b $c"
incr a
incr b
incr c
}
jim&gt; a
1 2 1
jim&gt; a
2 3 1</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The static variable <tt><em>a</em></tt> has no initialiser, so it is initialised from
the enclosing scope with the value 1. (Note that it is an error if there
is no variable with the same name in the enclosing scope). However <tt><em>b</em></tt>
has an initialiser, so it is initialised to 2.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unlike a local variable, the value of a static variable is retained across
invocations of the procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> command for information on how to define procedures
and what happens when they are invoked. See also NAMESPACES.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_variables_scalars_and_arrays">VARIABLES - SCALARS AND ARRAYS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl allows the definition of variables and the use of their values
either through <em>$</em>-style variable substitution, the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a>
command, or a few other mechanisms.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Variables need not be declared: a new variable will automatically
be created each time a new variable name is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl supports two types of variables: scalars and arrays.
A scalar variable has a single value, whereas an array variable
can have any number of elements, each with a name (called
its <em>index</em>) and a value.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Array indexes may be arbitrary strings; they need not be numeric.
Parentheses are used refer to array elements in Tcl commands.
For example, the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set x(first) 44</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will modify the element of <em>x</em> whose index is <em>first</em>
so that its new value is <em>44</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Two-dimensional arrays can be simulated in Tcl by using indexes
that contain multiple concatenated values.
For example, the commands</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a(2,3) 1
set a(3,6) 2</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>set the elements of <em>a</em> whose indexes are <em>2,3</em> and <em>3,6</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In general, array elements may be used anywhere in Tcl that scalar
variables may be used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an array is defined with a particular name, then there may
not be a scalar variable with the same name.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Similarly, if there is a scalar variable with a particular
name then it is not possible to make array references to the
variable.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>To convert a scalar variable to an array or vice versa, remove
the existing variable with the <a href="#_unset"><strong><tt>unset</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_array"><strong><tt>array</tt></strong></a> command provides several features for dealing
with arrays, such as querying the names of all the elements of
the array and converting between an array and a list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Variables may be either global or local. If a variable
name is used when a procedure isn&#8217;t being executed, then it
automatically refers to a global variable. Variable names used
within a procedure normally refer to local variables associated with that
invocation of the procedure. Local variables are deleted whenever
a procedure exits. Either <a href="#_global"><strong><tt>global</tt></strong></a> command may be used to request
that a name refer to a global variable for the duration of the current
procedure (this is somewhat analogous to <em>extern</em> in C), or the variable
may be explicitly scoped with the <tt>::</tt> prefix. For example</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a 1
set b 2
proc p {} {
set c 3
global a</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt> puts "$a $::b $c"
}
p</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will output:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>1 2 3</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_arrays_as_lists_in_jim">ARRAYS AS LISTS IN JIM</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unlike Tcl, Jim can automatically convert between a list (with an even
number of elements) and an array value. This is similar to the way Tcl
can convert between a string and a list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a {1 one 2 two}
puts $a(2)</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will output:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>two</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Thus <a href="#_array"><strong><tt>array</tt></strong></a> <tt>set</tt> is equivalent to <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> when the variable does not
exist or is empty.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The reverse is also true where an array will be converted into
a list.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a(1) one; set a(2) two
puts $a</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will output:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>1 one 2 two</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_dictionary_values">DICTIONARY VALUES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl 8.5 introduced the dict command, and Jim Tcl has added a version
of this command. Dictionaries provide efficient access to key-value
pairs, just like arrays, but dictionaries are pure values. This
means that you can pass them to a procedure just as a list or a
string. Tcl dictionaries are therefore much more like Tcl lists,
except that they represent a mapping from keys to values, rather
than an ordered sequence.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>You can nest dictionaries, so that the value for a particular key
consists of another dictionary. That way you can elegantly build
complicated data structures, such as hierarchical databases. You
can also combine dictionaries with other Tcl data structures. For
instance, you can build a list of dictionaries that themselves
contain lists.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Dictionaries are values that contain an efficient, order-preserving
mapping from arbitrary keys to arbitrary values. Each key in the
dictionary maps to a single value. They have a textual format that
is exactly that of any list with an even number of elements, with
each mapping in the dictionary being represented as two items in
the list. When a command takes a dictionary and produces a new
dictionary based on it (either returning it or writing it back into
the variable that the starting dictionary was read from) the new
dictionary will have the same order of keys, modulo any deleted
keys and with new keys added on to the end. When a string is
interpreted as a dictionary and it would otherwise have duplicate
keys, only the last value for a particular key is used; the others
are ignored, meaning that, "apple banana" and "apple carrot apple
banana" are equivalent dictionaries (with different string
representations).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that in Jim, arrays are implemented as dictionaries.
Thus automatic conversion between lists and dictionaries applies
as it does for arrays.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; dict set a 1 one
1 one
jim&gt; dict set a 2 two
1 one 2 two
jim&gt; puts $a
1 one 2 two
jim&gt; puts $a(2)
two
jim&gt; dict set a 3 T three
1 one 2 two 3 {T three}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the <a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> command for more details.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_namespaces">NAMESPACES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Tcl added namespaces as a mechanism avoiding name clashes, especially in applications
including a number of 3rd party components. While there is less need for namespaces
in Jim Tcl (which does not strive to support large applications), it is convenient to
provide a subset of the support for namespaces to easy porting code from Tcl.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim Tcl currently supports "light-weight" namespaces which should be adequate for most
purposes. This feature is currently experimental. See README.namespaces for more information
and the documentation of the <a href="#_namespace"><strong><tt>namespace</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_garbage_collection_references_lambda">GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Unlike Tcl, Jim has some sophisticated support for functional programming.
These are described briefly below.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>More information may be found at <a href="http://wiki.tcl.tk/13847">http://wiki.tcl.tk/13847</a></p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_references">References</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>A reference can be thought of as holding a value with one level of indirection,
where the value may be garbage collected when unreferenced.
Consider the following example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; set r [ref "One String" test]
&lt;reference.&lt;test___&gt;.00000000000000000000&gt;
jim&gt; getref $r
One String</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The operation <a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a> creates a references to the value specified by the
first argument. (The second argument is a "type" used for documentation purposes).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The operation <a href="#_getref"><strong><tt>getref</tt></strong></a> is the dereferencing operation which retrieves the value
stored in the reference.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; setref $r "New String"
New String
jim&gt; getref $r
New String</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The operation <a href="#_setref"><strong><tt>setref</tt></strong></a> replaces the value stored by the reference. If the old value
is no longer accessible by any reference, it will eventually be automatically be garbage
collected.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_garbage_collection">Garbage Collection</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally, all values in Tcl are passed by value. As such values are copied and released
automatically as necessary.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>With the introduction of references, it is possible to create values whose lifetime
transcend their scope. To support this, case, the Jim system will periodically identify
and discard objects which are no longer accessible by any reference.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_collect"><strong><tt>collect</tt></strong></a> command may be used to force garbage collection. Consider a reference created
with a finalizer:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; proc f {ref value} { puts "Finaliser called for $ref,$value" }
jim&gt; set r [ref "One String" test f]
&lt;reference.&lt;test___&gt;.00000000000
jim&gt; collect
0
jim&gt; set r ""
jim&gt; collect
Finaliser called for &lt;reference.&lt;test___&gt;.00000000000,One String
1</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that once the reference, <em>r</em>, was modified so that it no longer
contained a reference to the value, the garbage collector discarded
the value (after calling the finalizer).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The finalizer for a reference may be examined or changed with the <a href="#_finalize"><strong><tt>finalize</tt></strong></a> command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; finalize $r
f
jim&gt; finalize $r newf
newf</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lambda">Lambda</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim provides a garbage collected lambda function. This is a procedure
which is able to create an anonymous procedure. Consider:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; set f [lambda {a} {{x 0}} { incr x $a }]
jim&gt; $f 1
1
jim&gt; $f 2
3
jim&gt; set f ""</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This create an anonymous procedure (with the name stored in <em>f</em>), with a static variable
which is incremented by the supplied value and the result returned.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Once the procedure name is no longer accessible, it will automatically be deleted
when the garbage collector runs.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The procedure may also be delete immediately by renaming it "". e.g.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; rename $f ""</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_utf_8_and_unicode">UTF-8 AND UNICODE</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>If Jim is built with UTF-8 support enabled (configure --enable-utf),
then most string-related commands become UTF-8 aware. These include,
but are not limited to, <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>, <a href="#_split"><strong><tt>split</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_glob"><strong><tt>glob</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_scan"><strong><tt>scan</tt></strong></a> and
<a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>UTF-8 encoding has many advantages, but one of the complications is that
characters can take a variable number of bytes. Thus the addition of
<a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>bytelength</tt> which returns the number of bytes in a string,
while <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>length</tt> returns the number of characters.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If UTF-8 support is not enabled, all commands treat bytes as characters
and <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>bytelength</tt> returns the same value as <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>length</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that even if UTF-8 support is not enabled, the <tt>\uNNNN</tt> and related syntax
is still available to embed UTF-8 sequences.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim Tcl supports all currently defined unicode codepoints. That is 21 bits, up to +<em>U+1FFFFF</em>.</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_string_matching">String Matching</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Commands such as <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>, <a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-glob</tt>, <a href="#_array"><strong><tt>array</tt></strong></a> <tt>names</tt> and others use string
pattern matching rules. These commands support UTF-8. For example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>string match a\[\ua0-\ubf\]b "a\u00a3b"</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_format_and_scan">format and scan</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt>format %c</tt> allows a unicode codepoint to be be encoded. For example, the following will return
a string with two bytes and one character. The same as <tt>\ub5</tt></p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>format %c 0xb5</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a> respects widths as character widths, not byte widths. For example, the following will
return a string with three characters, not three bytes.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>format %.3s \ub5\ub6\ub7\ub8</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Similarly, <tt>scan &#8230; %c</tt> allows a UTF-8 to be decoded to a unicode codepoint. The following will set
<tt><em>a</em></tt> to 181 (0xb5) and <tt><em>b</em></tt> to 65 (0x41).</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>scan \u00b5A %c%c a b</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_scan"><strong><tt>scan</tt></strong></a> <tt>%s</tt> will also accept a character class, including unicode ranges.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_string_classes">String Classes</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>is</tt> has <strong>not</strong> been extended to classify UTF-8 characters. Therefore, the following
will return 0, even though the string may be considered to be alphabetic.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>string is alpha \ub5Test</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This does not affect the string classes <em>ascii</em>, <em>control</em>, <em>digit</em>, <em>double</em>, <em>integer</em> or <em>xdigit</em>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_case_mapping_and_conversion">Case Mapping and Conversion</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim provides a simplified unicode case mapping. This means that case conversion
and comparison will not increase or decrease the number of characters in a string.
(Although it may change the number of bytes).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>toupper</tt> will convert any lowercase letters to their uppercase equivalent.
Any character which is not a letter or has no uppercase equivalent is left unchanged.
Similarly for <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>tolower</tt> and <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>totitle</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Commands which perform case insensitive matches, such as <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>compare -nocase</tt>
and <a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-nocase</tt> fold both strings to uppercase before comparison.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_invalid_utf_8_sequences">Invalid UTF-8 Sequences</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Some UTF-8 character sequences are invalid, such as those beginning with <em>0xff</em>,
those which represent character sequences longer than 3 bytes (greater than U+FFFF),
and those which end prematurely, such as a lone <em>0xc2</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In these situations, the offending bytes are treated as single characters. For example,
the following returns 2.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>string bytelength \xff\xff</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_regular_expressions_2">Regular Expressions</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If UTF-8 support is enabled, the built-in regular expression engine will be
selected which supports UTF-8 strings and patterns.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See REGULAR EXPRESSIONS</p></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_built_in_commands">BUILT-IN COMMANDS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The Tcl library provides the following built-in commands, which will
be available in any application using Tcl. In addition to these
built-in commands, there may be additional commands defined by each
application, plus commands defined as Tcl procedures.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In the command syntax descriptions below, words in <tt><strong>boldface</strong></tt> are
literals that you type verbatim to Tcl.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Words in <tt><em>italics</em></tt> are meta-symbols; they serve as names for any of
a range of values that you can type.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Optional arguments or groups of arguments are indicated by enclosing them
in <tt>?question-marks?</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Ellipses (<tt>...</tt>) indicate that any number of additional
arguments or groups of arguments may appear, in the same format
as the preceding argument(s).</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="CommandIndex">Command Index</h3>
<div class="tableblock">
<table rules="none"
width="100%"
frame="void"
cellspacing="0" cellpadding="4">
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<col width="12%" />
<tbody>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>after</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_alarm"><strong><tt>alarm</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_append"><strong><tt>append</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_apply"><strong><tt>apply</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_array"><strong><tt>array</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_binary"><strong><tt>binary</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_case"><strong><tt>case</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_cd"><strong><tt>cd</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_4"><strong><tt>class</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_clock"><strong><tt>clock</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_close"><strong><tt>close</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_collect"><strong><tt>collect</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_curry"><strong><tt>curry</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_env"><strong><tt>env</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_eof"><strong><tt>eof</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_error"><strong><tt>error</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>eventloop</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_exists"><strong><tt>exists</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_exit"><strong><tt>exit</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_fconfigure"><strong><tt>fconfigure</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_finalize"><strong><tt>finalize</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_flush"><strong><tt>flush</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_getref"><strong><tt>getref</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_gets"><strong><tt>gets</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_glob"><strong><tt>glob</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_global"><strong><tt>global</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_history"><strong><tt>history</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_if"><strong><tt>if</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_incr"><strong><tt>incr</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_join"><strong><tt>join</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_kill"><strong><tt>kill</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lappend"><strong><tt>lappend</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lassign"><strong><tt>lassign</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_linsert"><strong><tt>linsert</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_list"><strong><tt>list</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_llength"><strong><tt>llength</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lmap"><strong><tt>lmap</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_load"><strong><tt>load</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_loop"><strong><tt>loop</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lrange"><strong><tt>lrange</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lrepeat"><strong><tt>lrepeat</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lreplace"><strong><tt>lreplace</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lreverse"><strong><tt>lreverse</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_lsort"><strong><tt>lsort</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_namespace"><strong><tt>namespace</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_4"><strong><tt>oo</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.fork</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.gethostname</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.getids</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.uptime</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.wait</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_3"><strong><tt>pack</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_3"><strong><tt>pack</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_package"><strong><tt>package</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_pid"><strong><tt>pid</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>posix</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_puts"><strong><tt>puts</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_pwd"><strong><tt>pwd</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_rand"><strong><tt>rand</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_range"><strong><tt>range</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_read"><strong><tt>read</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_regexp"><strong><tt>regexp</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_regsub"><strong><tt>regsub</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_rename"><strong><tt>rename</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_scan"><strong><tt>scan</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_seek"><strong><tt>seek</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_setref"><strong><tt>setref</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_sleep"><strong><tt>sleep</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_split"><strong><tt>split</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_stackdump"><strong><tt>stackdump</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_stacktrace"><strong><tt>stacktrace</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_subst"><strong><tt>subst</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_4"><strong><tt>super</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_syslog"><strong><tt>syslog</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_tailcall"><strong><tt>tailcall</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_tcl_prefix"><strong><tt>tcl::prefix</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_tell"><strong><tt>tell</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_throw"><strong><tt>throw</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_time"><strong><tt>time</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_tree"><strong><tt>tree</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_3"><strong><tt>unpack</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_unset"><strong><tt>unset</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_upcall"><strong><tt>upcall</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>update</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>vwait</tt></strong></a></p></td>
<td align="left" valign="top"><p class="table"><a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a></p></td>
</tr>
</tbody>
</table>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_alarm">alarm</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>alarm</strong> <em>seconds</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Delivers the <tt>SIGALRM</tt> signal to the process after the given
number of seconds. If the platform supports <em>ualarm(3)</em> then
the argument may be a floating point value. Otherwise it must
be an integer.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that unless a signal handler for <tt>SIGALRM</tt> has been installed
(see <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a>), the process will exit on this signal.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_alias">alias</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>alias</strong> <em>name args...</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Creates a single word alias (command) for one or more words. For example,
the following creates an alias for the command <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>exists</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>alias e info exists
if {[e var]} {
...
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a> returns <tt><em>name</em></tt>, allowing it to be used with <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_curry"><strong><tt>curry</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>alias</tt>, <a href="#_exists"><strong><tt>exists</tt></strong></a> <tt>-alias</tt></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_append">append</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>append</strong> <em>varName value ?value value &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Append all of the <tt><em>value</em></tt> arguments to the current value
of variable <tt><em>varName</em></tt>. If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> doesn&#8217;t exist,
it is given a value equal to the concatenation of all the
<tt><em>value</em></tt> arguments.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command provides an efficient way to build up long
variables incrementally.
For example, "<a href="#_append"><strong><tt>append</tt></strong></a> <tt>a $b</tt>" is much more efficient than
"<a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> <tt>a $a$b</tt>" if <tt>$a</tt> is long.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_apply">apply</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>apply</strong> <em>lambdaExpr ?arg1 arg2 ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The command <a href="#_apply"><strong><tt>apply</tt></strong></a> provides for anonymous procedure calls,
similar to <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a>, but without command name being created, even temporarily.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The function <tt><em>lambdaExpr</em></tt> is a two element list <tt>{args body}</tt>
or a three element list <tt>{args body namespace}</tt>. The first element
args specifies the formal arguments, in the same form as the <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a> commands.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_array">array</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>array</strong> <em>option arrayName ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command performs one of several operations on the
variable given by <tt><em>arrayName</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that in general, if the named array does not exist, the <tt><em>array</em></tt> command behaves
as though the array exists but is empty.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>option</em></tt> argument determines what action is carried out by the
command. The legal <tt><em>options</em></tt> (which may be abbreviated) are:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array exists</strong> <em>arrayName</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if arrayName is an array variable, 0 if there is
no variable by that name. This command is essentially
identical to <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>exists</tt>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array get</strong> <em>arrayName ?pattern?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list containing pairs of elements. The first
element in each pair is the name of an element in arrayName
and the second element of each pair is the value of the
array element. The order of the pairs is undefined. If
pattern is not specified, then all of the elements of the
array are included in the result. If pattern is specified,
then only those elements whose names match pattern (using
the matching rules of string match) are included. If arrayName
isn&#8217;t the name of an array variable, or if the array contains
no elements, then an empty list is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array names</strong> <em>arrayName ?pattern?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list containing the names of all of the elements
in the array that match pattern. If pattern is omitted then
the command returns all of the element names in the array.
If pattern is specified, then only those elements whose
names match pattern (using the matching rules of string
match) are included. If there are no (matching) elements
in the array, or if arrayName isn&#8217;t the name of an array
variable, then an empty string is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array set</strong> <em>arrayName list</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sets the values of one or more elements in arrayName. list
must have a form like that returned by array get, consisting
of an even number of elements. Each odd-numbered element
in list is treated as an element name within arrayName, and
the following element in list is used as a new value for
that array element. If the variable arrayName does not
already exist and list is empty, arrayName is created with
an empty array value.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array size</strong> <em>arrayName</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the number of elements in the array. If arrayName
isn&#8217;t the name of an array then 0 is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>array unset</strong> <em>arrayName ?pattern?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Unsets all of the elements in the array that match pattern
(using the matching rules of string match). If arrayName
isn&#8217;t the name of an array variable or there are no matching
elements in the array, no error will be raised. If pattern
is omitted and arrayName is an array variable, then the
command unsets the entire array. The command always returns
an empty string.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_break">break</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>break</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command may be invoked only inside the body of a loop command
such as <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a>. It returns a <tt>JIM_BREAK</tt> code
to signal the innermost containing loop command to return immediately.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_case">case</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>case</strong> <em>string</em> ?in? <em>patList body ?patList body &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>case</strong> <em>string</em> ?in? {<em>patList body ?patList body &#8230;?</em>}</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>Note</strong> that the <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> command should generally be preferred unless compatibility
with Tcl 6.x is desired.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Match <tt><em>string</em></tt> against each of the <tt><em>patList</em></tt> arguments
in order. If one matches, then evaluate the following <tt><em>body</em></tt> argument
by passing it recursively to the Tcl interpreter, and return the result
of that evaluation. Each <tt><em>patList</em></tt> argument consists of a single
pattern or list of patterns. Each pattern may contain any of the wild-cards
described under <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <tt><em>patList</em></tt> argument is <tt>default</tt>, the corresponding body will be
evaluated if no <tt><em>patList</em></tt> matches <tt><em>string</em></tt>. If no <tt><em>patList</em></tt> argument
matches <tt><em>string</em></tt> and no default is given, then the <a href="#_case"><strong><tt>case</tt></strong></a> command returns
an empty string.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Two syntaxes are provided.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The first uses a separate argument for each of the patterns and commands;
this form is convenient if substitutions are desired on some of the
patterns or commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The second form places all of the patterns and commands together into
a single argument; the argument must have proper list structure, with
the elements of the list being the patterns and commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The second form makes it easy to construct multi-line case commands,
since the braces around the whole list make it unnecessary to include a
backslash at the end of each line.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Since the <tt><em>patList</em></tt> arguments are in braces in the second form,
no command or variable substitutions are performed on them; this makes
the behaviour of the second form different than the first form in some
cases.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Below are some examples of <a href="#_case"><strong><tt>case</tt></strong></a> commands:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>case abc in {a b} {format 1} default {format 2} a* {format 3}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return <em>3</em>,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>case a in {
{a b} {format 1}
default {format 2}
a* {format 3}
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return <em>1</em>, and</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>case xyz {
{a b}
{format 1}
default
{format 2}
a*
{format 3}
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return <em>2</em>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_catch">catch</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>catch</strong> ?-?no?<em>code ...</em>? ?--? <em>command ?resultVarName? ?optionsVarName?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> command may be used to prevent errors from aborting
command interpretation. <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> evaluates <tt><em>command</em></tt>, and returns a
<tt>JIM_OK</tt> code, regardless of any errors that might occur while
executing <tt><em>command</em></tt> (with the possible exception of <tt>JIM_SIGNAL</tt> -
see below).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The return value from <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> is a decimal string giving the code
returned by the Tcl interpreter after executing <tt><em>command</em></tt>. This
will be <em>0</em> (<tt>JIM_OK</tt>) if there were no errors in <tt><em>command</em></tt>; otherwise
it will have a non-zero value corresponding to one of the exceptional
return codes (see jim.h for the definitions of code values, or the
<a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>returncodes</tt> command).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the <tt><em>resultVarName</em></tt> argument is given, then it gives the name
of a variable; <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> will set the value of the variable to the
string returned from <tt><em>command</em></tt> (either a result or an error message).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the <tt><em>optionsVarName</em></tt> argument is given, then it gives the name
of a variable; <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> will set the value of the variable to a
dictionary. For any return code other than <tt>JIM_RETURN</tt>, the value
for the key <tt>-code</tt> will be set to the return code. For <tt>JIM_RETURN</tt>
it will be set to the code given in <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> <tt>-code</tt>. Additionally,
for the return code <tt>JIM_ERR</tt>, the value of the key <tt>-errorinfo</tt>
will contain the current stack trace (the same result as <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>stacktrace</tt>),
the value of the key <tt>-errorcode</tt> will contain the
same value as the global variable $::errorCode, and the value of
the key <tt>-level</tt> will be the current return level (see <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> <tt>-level</tt>).
This can be useful to rethrow an error:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>if {[catch {...} msg opts]} {
...maybe do something with the error...
incr opts(-level)
return {*}$opts $msg
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> will <tt><em>not</em></tt> catch any of the codes <tt>JIM_EXIT</tt>, <tt>JIM_EVAL</tt> or <tt>JIM_SIGNAL</tt>.
The set of codes which will be caught may be modified by specifying the one more codes before
<tt><em>command</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>e.g. To catch <tt>JIM_EXIT</tt> but not <tt>JIM_BREAK</tt> or <tt>JIM_CONTINUE</tt></p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>catch -exit -nobreak -nocontinue -- { ... }</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The use of <tt>--</tt> is optional. It signifies that no more return code options follow.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that if a signal marked as <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>handle</tt> is caught with <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-signal</tt>, the return value
(stored in <tt><em>resultVarName</em></tt>) is name of the signal caught.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_cd">cd</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>cd</strong> <em>dirName</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Change the current working directory to <tt><em>dirName</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns an empty string.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command can potentially be disruptive to an application, so it may
be removed in some applications.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_clock">clock</h3>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>clock seconds</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the current time as seconds since the epoch.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>clock format</strong> <em>seconds</em> ?<strong>-format</strong> <em>format?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Format the given time (seconds since the epoch) according to the given
format. See strftime(3) for supported formats.
If no format is supplied, "%c" is used.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>clock scan</strong> <em>str</em> <strong>-format</strong> <em>format</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Scan the given time string using the given format string.
See strptime(3) for supported formats.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_close">close</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>close</strong> <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>close</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Closes the file given by <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>.
<tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must be the return value from a previous invocation
of the <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a> command; after this command, it should not be
used anymore.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_collect">collect</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>collect</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally reference garbage collection is automatically performed periodically.
However it may be run immediately with the <a href="#_collect"><strong><tt>collect</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_concat">concat</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>concat</strong> <em>arg ?arg ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command treats each argument as a list and concatenates them
into a single list. It permits any number of arguments. For example,
the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>concat a b {c d e} {f {g h}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>a b c d e f {g h}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>as its result.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_continue">continue</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>continue</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command may be invoked only inside the body of a loop command such
as <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a>. It returns a <tt>JIM_CONTINUE</tt> code to
signal the innermost containing loop command to skip the remainder of
the loop&#8217;s body but continue with the next iteration of the loop.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_curry">curry</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>alias</strong> <em>args...</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Similar to <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a> except it creates an anonymous procedure (lambda) instead of
a named procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>the following creates a local, unnamed alias for the command <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>exists</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set e [local curry info exists]
if {[$e var]} {
...
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_curry"><strong><tt>curry</tt></strong></a> returns the name of the procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_dict">dict</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>dict</strong> <em>option ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Performs one of several operations on dictionary values.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>option</em></tt> argument determines what action is carried out by the
command. The legal <tt><em>options</em></tt> are:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict create</strong> <em>?key value ...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Create and return a new dictionary value that contains each of
the key/value mappings listed as arguments (keys and values
alternating, with each key being followed by its associated
value.)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict exists</strong> <em>dictionary key ?key ...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a boolean value indicating whether the given key (or path
of keys through a set of nested dictionaries) exists in the given
dictionary value. This returns a true value exactly when <a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>get</tt>
on that path will succeed.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict get</strong> <em>dictionary ?key ...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Given a dictionary value (first argument) and a key (second argument),
this will retrieve the value for that key. Where several keys are
supplied, the behaviour of the command shall be as if the result
of "<a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>get $dictVal $key</tt>" was passed as the first argument to
dict get with the remaining arguments as second (and possibly
subsequent) arguments. This facilitates lookups in nested dictionaries.
If no keys are provided, dict would return a list containing pairs
of elements in a man- ner similar to array get. That is, the first
element of each pair would be the key and the second element would
be the value for that key. It is an error to attempt to retrieve
a value for a key that is not present in the dictionary.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict keys</strong> <em>dictionary ?pattern?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of the keys in the dictionary.
If pattern is specified, then only those keys whose
names match <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> (using the matching rules of string
match) are included.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict merge</strong> ?<em>dictionary ...</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return a dictionary that contains the contents of each of the
<tt><em>dictionary</em></tt> arguments. Where two (or more) dictionaries
contain a mapping for the same key, the resulting dictionary
maps that key to the value according to the last dictionary on
the command line containing a mapping for that key.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict set</strong> <em>dictionaryName key ?key ...? value</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This operation takes the <tt><em>name</em></tt> of a variable containing a dictionary
value and places an updated dictionary value in that variable
containing a mapping from the given key to the given value. When
multiple keys are present, this operation creates or updates a chain
of nested dictionaries.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict size</strong> <em>dictionary</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return the number of key/value mappings in the given dictionary value.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict unset</strong> <em>dictionaryName key ?key ...? value</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This operation (the companion to <a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>set</tt>) takes the name of a
variable containing a dictionary value and places an updated
dictionary value in that variable that does not contain a mapping
for the given key. Where multiple keys are present, this describes
a path through nested dictionaries to the mapping to remove. At
least one key must be specified, but the last key on the key-path
need not exist. All other components on the path must exist.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>dict with</strong> <em>dictionaryName key ?key ...? script</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Execute the Tcl script in <tt><em>script</em></tt> with the value for each
key in <tt><em>dictionaryName</em></tt> mapped to a variable with the same
name. Where one or more keys are given, these indicate a chain
of nested dictionaries, with the innermost dictionary being the
one opened out for the execution of body. Making <tt><em>dictionaryName</em></tt>
unreadable will make the updates to the dictionary be discarded,
and this also happens if the contents of <tt><em>dictionaryName</em></tt> are
adjusted so that the chain of dictionaries no longer exists.
The result of <a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>with</tt> is (unless some kind of error occurs)
the result of the evaluation of body.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The variables are mapped in the scope enclosing the <a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>with</tt>;
it is recommended that this command only be used in a local
scope (procedure). Because of this, the variables set by
<a href="#_dict"><strong><tt>dict</tt></strong></a> <tt>with</tt> will continue to exist after the command finishes (unless
explicitly unset). Note that changes to the contents of <tt><em>dictionaryName</em></tt>
only happen when <tt><em>script</em></tt> terminates.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_env">env</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>env</strong> <em>?name? ?default?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>name</em></tt> is supplied, returns the value of <tt><em>name</em></tt> from the initial
environment (see getenv(3)). An error is returned if <tt><em>name</em></tt> does not
exist in the environment, unless <tt><em>default</em></tt> is supplied - in which case
that value is returned instead.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no arguments are supplied, returns a list of all environment variables
and their values as <tt>{name value ...}</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also the global variable <tt>::env</tt></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_eof">eof</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>eof</strong> <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>eof</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns 1 if an end-of-file condition has occurred on <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>,
0 otherwise.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must have been the return value from a previous call to <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>,
or it may be <tt>stdin</tt>, <tt>stdout</tt>, or <tt>stderr</tt> to refer to one of the
standard I/O channels.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_error">error</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>error</strong> <em>message ?stacktrace?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a <tt>JIM_ERR</tt> code, which causes command interpretation to be
unwound. <tt><em>message</em></tt> is a string that is returned to the application
to indicate what went wrong.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the <tt><em>stacktrace</em></tt> argument is provided and is non-empty,
it is used to initialize the stacktrace.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This feature is most useful in conjunction with the <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> command:
if a caught error cannot be handled successfully, <tt><em>stacktrace</em></tt> can be used
to return a stack trace reflecting the original point of occurrence
of the error:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>catch {...} errMsg
...
error $errMsg [info stacktrace]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <tt>errorInfo</tt>, <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>stacktrace</tt>, <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_errorinfo">errorInfo</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>errorInfo</strong> <em>error ?stacktrace?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a human-readable representation of the given error message and stack trace.
Typical usage is:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>if {[catch {...} error]} {
puts stderr [errorInfo $error [info stacktrace]]
exit 1
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_error"><strong><tt>error</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_eval">eval</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>eval</strong> <em>arg ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a> takes one or more arguments, which together comprise a Tcl
command (or collection of Tcl commands separated by newlines in the
usual way). <a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a> concatenates all its arguments in the same
fashion as the <a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a> command, passes the concatenated string to the
Tcl interpreter recursively, and returns the result of that
evaluation (or any error generated by it).</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_exec">exec</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>exec</strong> <em>arg ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command treats its arguments as the specification
of one or more UNIX commands to execute as subprocesses.
The commands take the form of a standard shell pipeline;
<tt>|</tt> arguments separate commands in the
pipeline and cause standard output of the preceding command
to be piped into standard input of the next command (or <tt>|&amp;</tt> for
both standard output and standard error).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Under normal conditions the result of the <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> command
consists of the standard output produced by the last command
in the pipeline.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If any of the commands in the pipeline exit abnormally or
are killed or suspended, then <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> will return an error
and the error message will include the pipeline&#8217;s output followed by
error messages describing the abnormal terminations.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If any of the commands writes to its standard error file,
then <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> will return an error, and the error message
will include the pipeline&#8217;s output, followed by messages
about abnormal terminations (if any), followed by the standard error
output.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the last character of the result or error message
is a newline then that character is deleted from the result
or error message for consistency with normal
Tcl return values.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An <tt><em>arg</em></tt> may have one of the following special forms:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&gt;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard output of the last command in the pipeline
is redirected to the file. In this situation <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a>
will normally return an empty string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&gt;&gt;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
As above, but append to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&gt;@fileId</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard output of the last command in the pipeline is
redirected to the given (writable) file descriptor (e.g. stdout,
stderr, or the result of <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>). In this situation <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a>
will normally return an empty string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>2&gt;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard error of the last command in the pipeline
is redirected to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>2&gt;&gt;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
As above, but append to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>2&gt;@fileId</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard error of the last command in the pipeline is
redirected to the given (writable) file descriptor.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>2&gt;@1</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard error of the last command in the pipeline is
redirected to the same file descriptor as the standard output.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&gt;&amp;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Both the standard output and standard error of the last command
in the pipeline is redirected to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&gt;&gt;&amp;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
As above, but append to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&lt;filename</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard input of the first command in the pipeline
is taken from the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&lt;&lt;string</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard input of the first command is taken as the
given immediate value.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>&lt;@fileId</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The standard input of the first command in the pipeline
is taken from the given (readable) file descriptor.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If there is no redirection of standard input, standard error
or standard output, these are connected to the corresponding
input or output of the application.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the last <tt><em>arg</em></tt> is <tt>&amp;</tt> then the command will be
executed in background.
In this case the standard output from the last command
in the pipeline will
go to the application&#8217;s standard output unless
redirected in the command, and error output from all
the commands in the pipeline will go to the application&#8217;s
standard error file. The return value of exec in this case
is a list of process ids (pids) in the pipeline.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Each <tt><em>arg</em></tt> becomes one word for a command, except for
<tt>|</tt>, <tt>&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, <tt>&gt;</tt>, and <tt>&amp;</tt> arguments, and the
arguments that follow <tt>&lt;</tt>, <tt>&lt;&lt;</tt>, and <tt>&gt;</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The first word in each command is taken as the command name;
the directories in the PATH environment variable are searched for
an executable by the given name.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>No <a href="#_glob"><strong><tt>glob</tt></strong></a> expansion or other shell-like substitutions
are performed on the arguments to commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the command fails, the global $::errorCode (and the -errorcode
option in <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>) will be set to a list, as follows:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>CHILDKILLED</strong> <em>pid sigName msg</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This format is used when a child process has been killed
because of a signal. The pid element will be the process&#8217;s
identifier (in decimal). The sigName element will be the
symbolic name of the signal that caused the process to
terminate; it will be one of the names from the include
file signal.h, such as SIGPIPE. The msg element will be a
short human-readable message describing the signal, such
as "write on pipe with no readers" for SIGPIPE.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>CHILDSUSP</strong> <em>pid sigName msg</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This format is used when a child process has been suspended
because of a signal. The pid element will be the process&#8217;s
identifier, in decimal. The sigName element will be the
symbolic name of the signal that caused the process to
suspend; this will be one of the names from the include
file signal.h, such as SIGTTIN. The msg element will be a
short human-readable message describing the signal, such
as "background tty read" for SIGTTIN.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>CHILDSTATUS</strong> <em>pid code</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This format is used when a child process has exited with a
non-zero exit status. The pid element will be the process&#8217;s
identifier (in decimal) and the code element will be the
exit code returned by the process (also in decimal).
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The environment for the executed command is set from $::env (unless
this variable is unset, in which case the original environment is used).</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_exists">exists</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>exists ?-var|-proc|-command|-alias?</strong> <em>name</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Checks the existence of the given variable, procedure, command
or alias respectively and returns 1 if it exists or 0 if not. This command
provides a more simplified/convenient version of <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>exists</tt>,
<a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>procs</tt> and <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>commands</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the type is omitted, a type of <em>-var</em> is used. The type may be abbreviated.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_exit">exit</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>exit</strong> <em>?returnCode?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Terminate the process, returning <tt><em>returnCode</em></tt> to the
parent as the exit status.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>returnCode</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified then it defaults
to 0.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that exit can be caught with <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_expr">expr</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>expr</strong> <em>arg</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Calls the expression processor to evaluate <tt><em>arg</em></tt>, and returns
the result as a string. See the section EXPRESSIONS above.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that Jim supports a shorthand syntax for <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a> as <tt>$(...)</tt>
The following two are identical.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set x [expr {3 * 2 + 1}]
set x $(3 * 2 + 1)</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_file">file</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>file</strong> <em>option name ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Operate on a file or a file name. <tt><em>name</em></tt> is the name of a file.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>option</em></tt> indicates what to do with the file name. Any unique
abbreviation for <tt><em>option</em></tt> is acceptable. The valid options are:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file atime</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return a decimal string giving the time at which file <tt><em>name</em></tt>
was last accessed. The time is measured in the standard UNIX
fashion as seconds from a fixed starting time (often January 1, 1970).
If the file doesn&#8217;t exist or its access time cannot be queried then an
error is generated.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file copy ?-force?</strong> <em>source target</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Copies file <tt><em>source</em></tt> to file <tt><em>target</em></tt>. The source file must exist.
The target file must not exist, unless <tt>-force</tt> is specified.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file delete ?-force?</strong> <em>name...</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Deletes file or directory <tt><em>name</em></tt>. If the file or directory doesn&#8217;t exist, nothing happens.
If it can&#8217;t be deleted, an error is generated. Non-empty directories will not be deleted
unless the <tt>-force</tt> options is given. In this case no errors will be generated, even
if the file/directory can&#8217;t be deleted.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file dirname</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return all of the characters in <tt><em>name</em></tt> up to but not including
the last slash character. If there are no slashes in <tt><em>name</em></tt>
then return <tt>.</tt> (a single dot). If the last slash in <tt><em>name</em></tt> is its first
character, then return <tt>/</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file executable</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is executable by
the current user, <em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file exists</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> exists and the current user has
search privileges for the directories leading to it, <em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file extension</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return all of the characters in <tt><em>name</em></tt> after and including the
last dot in <tt><em>name</em></tt>. If there is no dot in <tt><em>name</em></tt> then return
the empty string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file isdirectory</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is a directory,
<em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file isfile</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is a regular file,
<em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file join</strong> <em>arg...</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Joins multiple path components. Note that if any components is
an absolute path, the preceding components are ignored.
Thus <tt>"<a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> join /tmp /root"</tt> returns <tt>"/root"</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file lstat</strong> <em>name varName</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Same as <em>stat</em> option (see below) except uses the <tt><em>lstat</em></tt>
kernel call instead of <tt><em>stat</em></tt>. This means that if <tt><em>name</em></tt>
refers to a symbolic link the information returned in <tt><em>varName</em></tt>
is for the link rather than the file it refers to. On systems that
don&#8217;t support symbolic links this option behaves exactly the same
as the <em>stat</em> option.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file mkdir</strong> <em>dir1 ?dir2...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Creates each directory specified. For each pathname <tt><em>dir</em></tt> specified,
this command will create all non-existing parent directories
as well as <tt><em>dir</em></tt> itself. If an existing directory is specified,
then no action is taken and no error is returned. Trying to
overwrite an existing file with a directory will result in an
error. Arguments are processed in the order specified, halting
at the first error, if any.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file mtime</strong> <em>name ?time?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return a decimal string giving the time at which file <tt><em>name</em></tt>
was last modified. The time is measured in the standard UNIX
fashion as seconds from a fixed starting time (often January 1, 1970).
If the file doesn&#8217;t exist or its modified time cannot be queried then an
error is generated. If <tt><em>time</em></tt> is given, sets the modification time
of the file to the given value.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file normalize</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return the normalized path of <tt><em>name</em></tt>. See <em>realpath(3)</em>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file owned</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is owned by the current user,
<em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file readable</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is readable by
the current user, <em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file readlink</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the value of the symbolic link given by <tt><em>name</em></tt> (i.e. the
name of the file it points to). If
<tt><em>name</em></tt> isn&#8217;t a symbolic link or its value cannot be read, then
an error is returned. On systems that don&#8217;t support symbolic links
this option is undefined.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file rename</strong> <em>oldname</em> <em>newname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Renames the file from the old name to the new name.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file rootname</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return all of the characters in <tt><em>name</em></tt> up to but not including
the last <em>.</em> character in the name. If <tt><em>name</em></tt> doesn&#8217;t contain
a dot, then return <tt><em>name</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file size</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return a decimal string giving the size of file <tt><em>name</em></tt> in bytes.
If the file doesn&#8217;t exist or its size cannot be queried then an
error is generated.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file stat</strong> <em>name varName</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Invoke the <em>stat</em> kernel call on <tt><em>name</em></tt>, and use the
variable given by <tt><em>varName</em></tt> to hold information returned from
the kernel call.
<tt><em>varName</em></tt> is treated as an array variable,
and the following elements of that variable are set: <em>atime</em>,
<em>ctime</em>, <em>dev</em>, <em>gid</em>, <em>ino</em>, <em>mode</em>, <em>mtime</em>,
<em>nlink</em>, <em>size</em>, <em>type</em>, <em>uid</em>.
Each element except <em>type</em> is a decimal string with the value of
the corresponding field from the <em>stat</em> return structure; see the
manual entry for <em>stat</em> for details on the meanings of the values.
The <em>type</em> element gives the type of the file in the same form
returned by the command <a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> <tt>type</tt>.
This command returns an empty string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file tail</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return all of the characters in <tt><em>name</em></tt> after the last slash.
If <tt><em>name</em></tt> contains no slashes then return <tt><em>name</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file tempfile</strong> <em>?template?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Creates and returns the name of a unique temporary file. If <tt><em>template</em></tt> is omitted, a
default template will be used to place the file in /tmp. See <em>mkstemp(3)</em> for
the format of the template and security concerns.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file type</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a string giving the type of file <tt><em>name</em></tt>, which will be
one of <tt>file</tt>, <tt>directory</tt>, <tt>characterSpecial</tt>,
<tt>blockSpecial</tt>, <tt>fifo</tt>, <tt>link</tt>, or <tt>socket</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>file writable</strong> <em>name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Return <em>1</em> if file <tt><em>name</em></tt> is writable by
the current user, <em>0</em> otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_file"><strong><tt>file</tt></strong></a> commands that return 0/1 results are often used in
conditional or looping commands, for example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>if {![file exists foo]} {
error {bad file name}
} else {
...
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_finalize">finalize</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>finalize</strong> <em>reference ?command?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>command</em></tt> is omitted, returns the finalizer command for the given reference.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Otherwise, sets a new finalizer command for the given reference. <tt><em>command</em></tt> may be
the empty string to remove the current finalizer.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The reference must be a valid reference create with the <a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a>
command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_flush">flush</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>flush</strong> <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>flush</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Flushes any output that has been buffered for <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>. <tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must
have been the return value from a previous call to <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>, or it may be
<tt>stdout</tt> or <tt>stderr</tt> to access one of the standard I/O streams; it must
refer to a file that was opened for writing. This command returns an
empty string.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_for">for</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>for</strong> <em>start test next body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> is a looping command, similar in structure to the C <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> statement.
The <tt><em>start</em></tt>, <tt><em>next</em></tt>, and <tt><em>body</em></tt> arguments must be Tcl command strings,
and <tt><em>test</em></tt> is an expression string.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> command first invokes the Tcl interpreter to execute <tt><em>start</em></tt>.
Then it repeatedly evaluates <tt><em>test</em></tt> as an expression; if the result is
non-zero it invokes the Tcl interpreter on <tt><em>body</em></tt>, then invokes the Tcl
interpreter on <tt><em>next</em></tt>, then repeats the loop. The command terminates
when <tt><em>test</em></tt> evaluates to 0.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a> command is invoked within <tt><em>body</em></tt> then any remaining
commands in the current execution of <tt><em>body</em></tt> are skipped; processing
continues by invoking the Tcl interpreter on <tt><em>next</em></tt>, then evaluating
<tt><em>test</em></tt>, and so on.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a> command is invoked within <tt><em>body</em></tt> or <tt><em>next</em></tt>, then the <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a>
command will return immediately.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The operation of <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a> are similar to the corresponding
statements in C.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> returns an empty string.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_foreach">foreach</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>foreach</strong> <em>varName list body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>foreach</strong> <em>varList list ?varList2 list2 ...? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In this command, <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is the name of a variable, <tt><em>list</em></tt>
is a list of values to assign to <tt><em>varName</em></tt>, and <tt><em>body</em></tt> is a
collection of Tcl commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For each field in <tt><em>list</em></tt> (in order from left to right), <a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a> assigns
the contents of the field to <tt><em>varName</em></tt> (as if the <a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a> command
had been used to extract the field), then calls the Tcl interpreter to
execute <tt><em>body</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If instead of being a simple name, <tt><em>varList</em></tt> is used, multiple assignments
are made each time through the loop, one for each element of <tt><em>varList</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, if there are two elements in <tt><em>varList</em></tt> and six elements in
the list, the loop will be executed three times.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the length of the list doesn&#8217;t evenly divide by the number of elements
in <tt><em>varList</em></tt>, the value of the remaining variables in the last iteration
of the loop are undefined.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a> statements may be invoked inside <tt><em>body</em></tt>,
with the same effect as in the <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a> returns an empty string.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_format">format</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>format</strong> <em>formatString ?arg ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command generates a formatted string in the same way as the
C <em>sprintf</em> procedure (it uses <em>sprintf</em> in its
implementation). <tt><em>formatString</em></tt> indicates how to format
the result, using <tt>%</tt> fields as in <em>sprintf</em>, and the additional
arguments, if any, provide values to be substituted into the result.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>All of the <em>sprintf</em> options are valid; see the <em>sprintf</em>
man page for details. Each <tt><em>arg</em></tt> must match the expected type
from the <tt>%</tt> field in <tt><em>formatString</em></tt>; the <a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a> command
converts each argument to the correct type (floating, integer, etc.)
before passing it to <em>sprintf</em> for formatting.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The only unusual conversion is for <tt>%c</tt>; in this case the argument
must be a decimal string, which will then be converted to the corresponding
ASCII character value.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a> does backslash substitution on its <tt><em>formatString</em></tt>
argument, so backslash sequences in <tt><em>formatString</em></tt> will be handled
correctly even if the argument is in braces.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The return value from <a href="#_format"><strong><tt>format</tt></strong></a> is the formatted string.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_getref">getref</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>getref</strong> <em>reference</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns the string associated with <tt><em>reference</em></tt>. The reference must
be a valid reference create with the <a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_gets">gets</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>gets</strong> <em>fileId ?varName?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>gets</strong> <em>?varName?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Reads the next line from the file given by <tt><em>fileId</em></tt> and discards
the terminating newline character.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is specified, then the line is placed in the variable
by that name and the return value is a count of the number of characters
read (not including the newline).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the end of the file is reached before reading
any characters then -1 is returned and <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is set to an
empty string.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is not specified then the return value will be
the line (minus the newline character) or an empty string if
the end of the file is reached before reading any characters.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An empty string will also be returned if a line contains no characters
except the newline, so <a href="#_eof"><strong><tt>eof</tt></strong></a> may have to be used to determine
what really happened.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the last character in the file is not a newline character, then
<a href="#_gets"><strong><tt>gets</tt></strong></a> behaves as if there were an additional newline character
at the end of the file.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must be <tt>stdin</tt> or the return value from a previous
call to <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>; it must refer to a file that was opened
for reading.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_glob">glob</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>glob</strong> ?<strong>-nocomplain</strong>? <em>pattern ?pattern ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command performs filename globbing, using csh rules. The returned
value from <a href="#_glob"><strong><tt>glob</tt></strong></a> is the list of expanded filenames.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-nocomplain</tt> is specified as the first argument then an empty
list may be returned; otherwise an error is returned if the expanded
list is empty. The <tt>-nocomplain</tt> argument must be provided
exactly: an abbreviation will not be accepted.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_global">global</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>global</strong> <em>varName ?varName ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command is ignored unless a Tcl procedure is being interpreted.
If so, then it declares each given <tt><em>varName</em></tt> to be a global variable
rather than a local one. For the duration of the current procedure
(and only while executing in the current procedure), any reference to
<tt><em>varName</em></tt> will be bound to a global variable instead
of a local one.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An alternative to using <a href="#_global"><strong><tt>global</tt></strong></a> is to use the <tt>::</tt> prefix
to explicitly name a variable in the global scope.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_if">if</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>if</strong> <em>expr1</em> ?<strong>then</strong>? <em>body1</em> <strong>elseif</strong> <em>expr2</em> ?<strong>then</strong>? <em>body2</em> <strong>elseif</strong> ... ?<strong>else</strong>? ?<em>bodyN</em>?</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_if"><strong><tt>if</tt></strong></a> command evaluates <tt><em>expr1</em></tt> as an expression (in the same way
that <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a> evaluates its argument). The value of the expression must
be numeric; if it is non-zero then <tt><em>body1</em></tt> is executed by passing it to
the Tcl interpreter.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Otherwise <tt><em>expr2</em></tt> is evaluated as an expression and if it is non-zero
then <tt><em>body2</em></tt> is executed, and so on.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If none of the expressions evaluates to non-zero then <tt><em>bodyN</em></tt> is executed.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt>then</tt> and <tt>else</tt> arguments are optional "noise words" to make the
command easier to read.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>There may be any number of <tt>elseif</tt> clauses, including zero. <tt><em>bodyN</em></tt>
may also be omitted as long as <tt>else</tt> is omitted too.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The return value from the command is the result of the body script that
was executed, or an empty string if none of the expressions was non-zero
and there was no <tt><em>bodyN</em></tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_incr">incr</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>incr</strong> <em>varName ?increment?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Increment the value stored in the variable whose name is <tt><em>varName</em></tt>.
The value of the variable must be integral.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>increment</em></tt> is supplied then its value (which must be an
integer) is added to the value of variable <tt><em>varName</em></tt>; otherwise
1 is added to <tt><em>varName</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The new value is stored as a decimal string in variable <tt><em>varName</em></tt>
and also returned as result.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the variable does not exist, the variable is implicitly created
and set to <tt>0</tt> first.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_info">info</h3>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info</strong> <em>option ?arg...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Provide information about various internals to the Tcl interpreter.
The legal <tt><em>option</em></tt>'s (which may be abbreviated) are:
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info args</strong> <em>procname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list containing the names of the arguments to procedure
<tt><em>procname</em></tt>, in order. <tt><em>procname</em></tt> must be the name of a
Tcl command procedure.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info alias</strong> <em>command</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt><em>command</em></tt> must be an alias created with <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a>. In which case the target
command and arguments, as passed to <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a> are returned. See <a href="#_exists"><strong><tt>exists</tt></strong></a> <tt>-alias</tt>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info body</strong> <em>procname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the body of procedure <tt><em>procname</em></tt>. <tt><em>procname</em></tt> must be
the name of a Tcl command procedure.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info channels</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of all open file handles from <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info commands</strong> ?<em>pattern</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified, returns a list of names of all the
Tcl commands, including both the built-in commands written in C and
the command procedures defined using the <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> command.
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is specified, only those names matching <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>
are returned. Matching is determined using the same rules as for
<a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info complete</strong> <em>command</em> ?<em>missing</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if <tt><em>command</em></tt> is a complete Tcl command in the sense of
having no unclosed quotes, braces, brackets or array element names,
If the command doesn&#8217;t appear to be complete then 0 is returned.
This command is typically used in line-oriented input environments
to allow users to type in commands that span multiple lines; if the
command isn&#8217;t complete, the script can delay evaluating it until additional
lines have been typed to complete the command. If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is specified, the
missing character is stored in the variable with that name.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info exists</strong> <em>varName</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns <em>1</em> if the variable named <tt><em>varName</em></tt> exists in the
current context (either as a global or local variable), returns <em>0</em>
otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info frame</strong> ?<em>number</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>number</em></tt> is not specified, this command returns a number
which is the same result as <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>level</tt> - the current stack frame level.
If <tt><em>number</em></tt> is specified, then the result is a list consisting of the procedure,
filename and line number for the procedure call at level <tt><em>number</em></tt> on the stack.
If <tt><em>number</em></tt> is positive then it selects a particular stack level (1 refers
to the top-most active procedure, 2 to the procedure it called, and
so on); otherwise it gives a level relative to the current level
(0 refers to the current procedure, -1 to its caller, and so on).
The level has an identical meaning to <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>level</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info globals</strong> ?<em>pattern</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified, returns a list of all the names
of currently-defined global variables.
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is specified, only those names matching <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>
are returned. Matching is determined using the same rules as for
<a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info hostname</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
An alias for <a href="#cmd_1"><strong><tt>os.gethostname</tt></strong></a> for compatibility with Tcl 6.x
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info level</strong> ?<em>number</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>number</em></tt> is not specified, this command returns a number
giving the stack level of the invoking procedure, or 0 if the
command is invoked at top-level. If <tt><em>number</em></tt> is specified,
then the result is a list consisting of the name and arguments for the
procedure call at level <tt><em>number</em></tt> on the stack. If <tt><em>number</em></tt>
is positive then it selects a particular stack level (1 refers
to the top-most active procedure, 2 to the procedure it called, and
so on); otherwise it gives a level relative to the current level
(0 refers to the current procedure, -1 to its caller, and so on).
See the <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> command for more information on what stack
levels mean.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info locals</strong> ?<em>pattern</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified, returns a list of all the names
of currently-defined local variables, including arguments to the
current procedure, if any. Variables defined with the <a href="#_global"><strong><tt>global</tt></strong></a>
and <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> commands will not be returned. If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is
specified, only those names matching <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> are returned.
Matching is determined using the same rules as for <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info nameofexecutable</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the name of the binary file from which the application
was invoked. A full path will be returned, unless the path
can&#8217;t be determined, in which case the empty string will be returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info procs</strong> ?<em>pattern</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified, returns a list of all the
names of Tcl command procedures.
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is specified, only those names matching <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>
are returned. Matching is determined using the same rules as for
<a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info references</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of all references which have not yet been garbage
collected.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info returncodes</strong> ?<em>code</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list representing the mapping of standard return codes
to names. e.g. <tt>{0 ok 1 error 2 return ...}</tt>. If a code is given,
instead returns the name for the given code.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info script</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If a Tcl script file is currently being evaluated (i.e. there is a
call to <em>Jim_EvalFile</em> active or there is an active invocation
of the <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command), then this command returns the name
of the innermost file being processed. Otherwise the command returns an
empty string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info source</strong> <em>script</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the original source location of the given script as a list of
<tt>{filename linenumber}</tt>. If the source location can&#8217;t be determined, the
list <tt>{{} 0}</tt> is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info stacktrace</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
After an error is caught with <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>, returns the stack trace as a list
of <tt>{procedure filename line ...}</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info statics</strong> <em>procname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a dictionary of the static variables of procedure
<tt><em>procname</em></tt>. <tt><em>procname</em></tt> must be the name of a Tcl command
procedure. An empty dictionary is returned if the procedure has
no static variables.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info version</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the version number for this version of Jim in the form <tt><strong>x.yy</strong></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>info vars</strong> ?<em>pattern</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> isn&#8217;t specified,
returns a list of all the names of currently-visible variables, including
both locals and currently-visible globals.
If <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is specified, only those names matching <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>
are returned. Matching is determined using the same rules as for
<a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>match</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_join">join</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>join</strong> <em>list ?joinString?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>list</em></tt> argument must be a valid Tcl list. This command returns the
string formed by joining all of the elements of <tt><em>list</em></tt> together with
<tt><em>joinString</em></tt> separating each adjacent pair of elements.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>joinString</em></tt> argument defaults to a space character.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_kill">kill</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>kill</strong> ?<em>SIG</em>|<strong>-0</strong>? <em>pid</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Sends the given signal to the process identified by <tt><em>pid</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The signal may be specified by name or number in one of the following forms:</p></div>
<div class="ulist"><ul>
<li>
<p>
<tt>TERM</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt>SIGTERM</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt>-TERM</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt>15</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<tt>-15</tt>
</p>
</li>
</ul></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The signal name may be in either upper or lower case.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The special signal name <tt>-0</tt> simply checks that a signal <tt><em>could</em></tt> be sent.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no signal is specified, SIGTERM is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An error is raised if the signal could not be delivered.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lambda_2">lambda</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lambda</strong> <em>args ?statics? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a> command is identical to <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a>, except rather than
creating a named procedure, it creates an anonymous procedure and returns
the name of the procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> and GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lappend">lappend</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lappend</strong> <em>varName value ?value value ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Treat the variable given by <tt><em>varName</em></tt> as a list and append each of
the <tt><em>value</em></tt> arguments to that list as a separate element, with spaces
between elements.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> doesn&#8217;t exist, it is created as a list with elements given
by the <tt><em>value</em></tt> arguments. <a href="#_lappend"><strong><tt>lappend</tt></strong></a> is similar to <a href="#_append"><strong><tt>append</tt></strong></a> except that
each <tt><em>value</em></tt> is appended as a list element rather than raw text.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command provides a relatively efficient way to build up large lists.
For example,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>lappend a $b</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>is much more efficient than</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a [concat $a [list $b]]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>when <tt>$a</tt> is long.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lassign">lassign</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lassign</strong> <em>list varName ?varName ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command treats the value <tt><em>list</em></tt> as a list and assigns successive elements from that list to
the variables given by the <tt><em>varName</em></tt> arguments in order. If there are more variable names than
list elements, the remaining variables are set to the empty string. If there are more list ele-
ments than variables, a list of unassigned elements is returned.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; lassign {1 2 3} a b; puts a=$a,b=$b
3
a=1,b=2</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_local">local</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>local</strong> <em>cmd ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>First, <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a> evaluates <tt><em>cmd</em></tt> with the given arguments. The return value must
be the name of an existing command, which is marked as having local scope.
This means that when the current procedure exits, the specified
command is deleted. This can be useful with <a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a>, local procedures or
to automatically close a filehandle.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In addition, if a command already exists with the same name,
the existing command will be kept rather than deleted, and may be called
via <a href="#_upcall"><strong><tt>upcall</tt></strong></a>. The previous command will be restored when the current
procedure exits. See <a href="#_upcall"><strong><tt>upcall</tt></strong></a> for more details.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In this example, a local procedure is created. Note that the procedure
continues to have global scope while it is active.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>proc outer {} {
# proc ... returns "inner" which is marked local
local proc inner {} {
# will be deleted when 'outer' exits
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt> inner
...
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In this example, the lambda is deleted at the end of the procedure rather
than waiting until garbage collection.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>proc outer {} {
set x [lambda inner {args} {
# will be deleted when 'outer' exits
}]
# Use 'function' here which simply returns $x
local function $x</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt> $x ...
...
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_loop">loop</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>loop</strong> <em>var first limit ?incr? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Similar to <a href="#_for"><strong><tt>for</tt></strong></a> except simpler and possibly more efficient.
With a positive increment, equivalent to:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>for {set var $first} {$var &lt; $limit} {incr var $incr} $body</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>incr</em></tt> is not specified, 1 is used.
Note that setting the loop variable inside the loop does not
affect the loop count.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lindex">lindex</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lindex</strong> <em>list index</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Treats <tt><em>list</em></tt> as a Tcl list and returns element <tt><em>index</em></tt> from it
(0 refers to the first element of the list).
See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>index</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In extracting the element, <tt><em>lindex</em></tt> observes the same rules concerning
braces and quotes and backslashes as the Tcl command interpreter; however,
variable substitution and command substitution do not occur.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>index</em></tt> is negative or greater than or equal to the number of elements
in <tt><em>value</em></tt>, then an empty string is returned.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_linsert">linsert</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>linsert</strong> <em>list index element ?element element ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command produces a new list from <tt><em>list</em></tt> by inserting all
of the <tt><em>element</em></tt> arguments just before the element <tt><em>index</em></tt>
of <tt><em>list</em></tt>. Each <tt><em>element</em></tt> argument will become
a separate element of the new list. If <tt><em>index</em></tt> is less than
or equal to zero, then the new elements are inserted at the
beginning of the list. If <tt><em>index</em></tt> is greater than or equal
to the number of elements in the list, then the new elements are
appended to the list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>index</em></tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_list">list</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>list</strong> <em>arg ?arg ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command returns a list comprised of all the arguments, <tt><em>arg</em></tt>. Braces
and backslashes get added as necessary, so that the <a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a> command
may be used on the result to re-extract the original arguments, and also
so that <a href="#_eval"><strong><tt>eval</tt></strong></a> may be used to execute the resulting list, with
<tt><em>arg1</em></tt> comprising the command&#8217;s name and the other args comprising
its arguments. <a href="#_list"><strong><tt>list</tt></strong></a> produces slightly different results than
<a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a>: <a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a> removes one level of grouping before forming
the list, while <a href="#_list"><strong><tt>list</tt></strong></a> works directly from the original arguments.
For example, the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>list a b {c d e} {f {g h}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>a b {c d e} {f {g h}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>while <a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a> with the same arguments will return</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>a b c d e f {g h}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_llength">llength</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>llength</strong> <em>list</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Treats <tt><em>list</em></tt> as a list and returns a decimal string giving
the number of elements in it.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lset">lset</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lset</strong> <em>varName ?index ..? newValue</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Sets an element in a list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a> command accepts a parameter, <tt><em>varName</em></tt>, which it interprets
as the name of a variable containing a Tcl list. It also accepts
zero or more indices into the list. Finally, it accepts a new value
for an element of varName. If no indices are presented, the command
takes the form:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>lset varName newValue</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In this case, newValue replaces the old value of the variable
varName.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When presented with a single index, the <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a> command
treats the content of the varName variable as a Tcl list. It addresses
the index&#8217;th element in it (0 refers to the first element of the
list). When interpreting the list, <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a> observes the same rules
concerning braces and quotes and backslashes as the Tcl command
interpreter; however, variable substitution and command substitution
do not occur. The command constructs a new list in which the
designated element is replaced with newValue. This new list is
stored in the variable varName, and is also the return value from
the <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If index is negative or greater than or equal to the number of
elements in $varName, then an error occurs.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>index</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If additional index arguments are supplied, then each argument is
used in turn to address an element within a sublist designated by
the previous indexing operation, allowing the script to alter
elements in sublists. The command,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>lset a 1 2 newValue</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>replaces element 2 of sublist 1 with <tt><em>newValue</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The integer appearing in each index argument must be greater than
or equal to zero. The integer appearing in each index argument must
be strictly less than the length of the corresponding list. In other
words, the <a href="#_lset"><strong><tt>lset</tt></strong></a> command cannot change the size of a list. If an
index is outside the permitted range, an error is reported.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lmap">lmap</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lmap</strong> <em>varName list body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lmap</strong> <em>varList list ?varList2 list2 ...? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_lmap"><strong><tt>lmap</tt></strong></a> is a "collecting" <a href="#_foreach"><strong><tt>foreach</tt></strong></a> which returns a list of its results.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; lmap i {1 2 3 4 5} {expr $i*$i}
1 4 9 16 25
jim&gt; lmap a {1 2 3} b {A B C} {list $a $b}
{1 A} {2 B} {3 C}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the body invokes <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a>, no value is added for this iteration.
If the body invokes <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a>, the loop ends and no more values are added.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_load">load</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>load</strong> <em>filename</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Loads the dynamic extension, <tt><em>filename</em></tt>. Generally the filename should have
the extension <tt>.so</tt>. The initialisation function for the module must be based
on the name of the file. For example loading <tt>hwaccess.so</tt> will invoke
the initialisation function, <tt>Jim_hwaccessInit</tt>. Normally the <a href="#_load"><strong><tt>load</tt></strong></a> command
should not be used directly. Instead it is invoked automatically by <a href="#_package"><strong><tt>package</tt></strong></a> <tt>require</tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lrange">lrange</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lrange</strong> <em>list first last</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>list</em></tt> must be a valid Tcl list. This command will return a new
list consisting of elements <tt><em>first</em></tt> through <tt><em>last</em></tt>, inclusive.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>first</em></tt> and <tt><em>last</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>last</em></tt> is greater than or equal to the number of elements
in the list, then it is treated as if it were <tt>end</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is greater than <tt><em>last</em></tt> then an empty string
is returned.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note: <tt>"<a href="#_lrange"><strong><tt>lrange</tt></strong></a> <em>list first first</em>"</tt> does not always produce the
same result as <tt>"<a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a> <em>list first</em>"</tt> (although it often does
for simple fields that aren&#8217;t enclosed in braces); it does, however,
produce exactly the same results as <tt>"<a href="#_list"><strong><tt>list</tt></strong></a> [<a href="#_lindex"><strong><tt>lindex</tt></strong></a> <em>list first</em>]"</tt></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lreplace">lreplace</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lreplace</strong> <em>list first last ?element element ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a new list formed by replacing one or more elements of
<tt><em>list</em></tt> with the <tt><em>element</em></tt> arguments.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>first</em></tt> gives the index in <tt><em>list</em></tt> of the first element
to be replaced.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is less than zero then it refers to the first
element of <tt><em>list</em></tt>; the element indicated by <tt><em>first</em></tt>
must exist in the list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>last</em></tt> gives the index in <tt><em>list</em></tt> of the last element
to be replaced; it must be greater than or equal to <tt><em>first</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>first</em></tt> and <tt><em>last</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>element</em></tt> arguments specify zero or more new arguments to
be added to the list in place of those that were deleted.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Each <tt><em>element</em></tt> argument will become a separate element of
the list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no <tt><em>element</em></tt> arguments are specified, then the elements
between <tt><em>first</em></tt> and <tt><em>last</em></tt> are simply deleted.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lrepeat">lrepeat</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lrepeat</strong> <em>number element1 ?element2 ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Build a list by repeating elements <tt><em>number</em></tt> times (which must be
a positive integer).</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; lrepeat 3 a b
a b a b a b</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lreverse">lreverse</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lreverse</strong> <em>list</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns the list in reverse order.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; lreverse {1 2 3}
3 2 1</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lsearch">lsearch</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lsearch</strong> <em>?options? list pattern</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command searches the elements <tt><em>list</em></tt> to see if one of them matches <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>. If so, the
command returns the index of the first matching element (unless the options <tt>-all</tt>, <tt>-inline</tt> or <tt>-bool</tt> are
specified.) If not, the command returns -1. The option arguments indicates how the elements of
the list are to be matched against pattern and must have one of the values below:</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>Note</strong> that this command is different from Tcl in that default match type is <tt>-exact</tt> rather than <tt>-glob</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-exact</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is a literal string that is compared for exact equality against each list element.
This is the default.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-glob</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is a glob-style pattern which is matched against each list element using the same
rules as the string match command.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-regexp</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt><em>pattern</em></tt> is treated as a regular expression and matched against each list element using
the rules described by <a href="#_regexp"><strong><tt>regexp</tt></strong></a>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-command</strong> <em>cmdname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt><em>cmdname</em></tt> is a command which is used to match the pattern against each element of the
list. It is invoked as <tt><em>cmdname</em> ?<strong>-nocase</strong>? <em>pattern listvalue</em></tt> and should return 1
for a match, or 0 for no match.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-all</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Changes the result to be the list of all matching indices (or all matching values if
<tt>-inline</tt> is specified as well). If indices are returned, the indices will be in numeric
order. If values are returned, the order of the values will be the order of those values
within the input list.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-inline</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The matching value is returned instead of its index (or an empty string if no value
matches). If <tt>-all</tt> is also specified, then the result of the command is the list of all
values that matched. The <tt>-inline</tt> and <tt>-bool</tt> options are mutually exclusive.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-bool</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Changes the result to <em>1</em> if a match was found, or <em>0</em> otherwise. If <tt>-all</tt> is also specified,
the result will be a list of <em>0</em> and <em>1</em> for each element of the list depending upon whether
the corresponding element matches. The <tt>-inline</tt> and <tt>-bool</tt> options are mutually exclusive.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-not</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This negates the sense of the match, returning the index (or value
if <tt>-inline</tt> is specified) of the first non-matching value in the
list. If <tt>-bool</tt> is also specified, the <em>0</em> will be returned if a
match is found, or <em>1</em> otherwise. If <tt>-all</tt> is also specified,
non-matches will be returned rather than matches.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-nocase</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Causes comparisons to be handled in a case-insensitive manner.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_lsort">lsort</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>lsort</strong> ?<strong>-index</strong> <em>listindex</em>? ?<strong>-integer</strong>|<strong>-command</strong> <em>cmdname</em>? ?<strong>-decreasing</strong>|<strong>-increasing</strong>? <em>list</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Sort the elements of <tt><em>list</em></tt>, returning a new list in sorted order.
By default, ASCII sorting is used, with the result in increasing order.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-integer</tt> is specified, numeric sorting is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-command <em>cmdname</em></tt> is specified, <tt><em>cmdname</em></tt> is treated as a command
name. For each comparison, <tt><em>cmdname $value1 $value2</tt></em> is called which
should compare the values and return an integer less than, equal
to, or greater than zero if the <tt><em>$value1</em></tt> is to be considered less
than, equal to, or greater than <tt><em>$value2</em></tt>, respectively.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-decreasing</tt> is specified, the resulting list is in the opposite
order to what it would be otherwise. <tt>-increasing</tt> is the default.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-index <em>listindex</em></tt> is specified, each element of the list is treated as a list and
the given index is extracted from the list for comparison. The list index may
be any valid list index, such as <tt>1</tt>, <tt>end</tt> or <tt>end-2</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-index <em>listindex</em></tt> is specified, each element of the list is treated as a list and
the given index is extracted from the list for comparison. The list index may
be any valid list index, such as <tt>1</tt>, <tt>end</tt> or <tt>end-2</tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_open">open</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>open</strong> <em>fileName ?access?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>open</strong> <em>|command-pipeline ?access?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Opens a file and returns an identifier
that may be used in future invocations
of commands like <a href="#_read"><strong><tt>read</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_puts"><strong><tt>puts</tt></strong></a>, and <a href="#_close"><strong><tt>close</tt></strong></a>.
<tt><em>fileName</em></tt> gives the name of the file to open.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>access</em></tt> argument indicates the way in which the file is to be accessed.
It may have any of the following values:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>r</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for reading only; the file must already exist.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>r</tt>+
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for both reading and writing; the file must
already exist.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>w</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for writing only. Truncate it if it exists. If it doesn&#8217;t
exist, create a new file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>w</tt>+
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for reading and writing. Truncate it if it exists.
If it doesn&#8217;t exist, create a new file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>a</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for writing only. The file must already exist, and the file
is positioned so that new data is appended to the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>a</tt>+
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Open the file for reading and writing. If the file doesn&#8217;t
exist, create a new empty file. Set the initial access position
to the end of the file.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>access</em></tt> defaults to <em>r</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a file is opened for both reading and writing, then <a href="#_seek"><strong><tt>seek</tt></strong></a>
must be invoked between a read and a write, or vice versa.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the first character of <tt><em>fileName</em></tt> is "|" then the remaining
characters of <tt><em>fileName</em></tt> are treated as a list of arguments that
describe a command pipeline to invoke, in the same style as the
arguments for exec. In this case, the channel identifier returned
by open may be used to write to the command&#8217;s input pipe or read
from its output pipe, depending on the value of <tt><em>access</em></tt>. If write-only
access is used (e.g. <tt><em>access</em></tt> is <em>w</em>), then standard output for the
pipeline is directed to the current standard output unless overridden
by the command. If read-only access is used (e.g. <tt><em>access</em></tt> is r),
standard input for the pipeline is taken from the current standard
input unless overridden by the command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_pid"><strong><tt>pid</tt></strong></a> command may be used to return the process ids of the commands
forming the command pipeline.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_pid"><strong><tt>pid</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_package">package</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>package provide</strong> <em>name ?version?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Indicates that the current script provides the package named <tt><em>name</em></tt>.
If no version is specified, <em>1.0</em> is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Any script which provides a package may include this statement
as the first statement, although it is not required.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>package require</strong> <em>name ?version?</em>*</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Searches for the package with the given <tt><em>name</em></tt> by examining each path
in <em>$::auto_path</em> and trying to load <em>$path/$name.so</em> as a dynamic extension,
or <em>$path/$name.tcl</em> as a script package.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The first such file which is found is considered to provide the the package.
(The version number is ignored).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <em>$name.so</em> exists, it is loaded with the <a href="#_load"><strong><tt>load</tt></strong></a> command,
otherwise if <em>$name.tcl</em> exists it is loaded with the <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <a href="#_load"><strong><tt>load</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> fails, <a href="#_package"><strong><tt>package</tt></strong></a> <tt>require</tt> will fail immediately.
No further attempt will be made to locate the file.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_pid">pid</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>pid</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>pid</strong> <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The first form returns the process identifier of the current process.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The second form accepts a handle returned by <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a> and returns a list
of the process ids forming the pipeline in the same form as <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> <tt>... &amp;</tt>.
If <em>fileId</em> represents a regular file handle rather than a command pipeline,
the empty string is returned instead.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a></p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_proc">proc</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>proc</strong> <em>name args ?statics? body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> command creates a new Tcl command procedure, <tt><em>name</em></tt>.
When the new command is invoked, the contents of <tt><em>body</em></tt> will be executed.
Tcl interpreter. <tt><em>args</em></tt> specifies the formal arguments to the procedure.
If specified, <tt><em>static</em></tt>, declares static variables which are bound to the
procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See PROCEDURES for detailed information about Tcl procedures.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> command returns <tt><em>name</em></tt> (which is useful with <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a>).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When a procedure is invoked, the procedure&#8217;s return value is the
value specified in a <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> command. If the procedure doesn&#8217;t
execute an explicit <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a>, then its return value is the value
of the last command executed in the procedure&#8217;s body.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If an error occurs while executing the procedure body, then the
procedure-as-a-whole will return that same error.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_puts">puts</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>puts</strong> ?<strong>-nonewline</strong>? <em>?fileId? string</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>puts</strong> ?<strong>-nonewline</strong>? <em>string</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Writes the characters given by <tt><em>string</em></tt> to the file given
by <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>. <tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must have been the return
value from a previous call to <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>, or it may be
<tt>stdout</tt> or <tt>stderr</tt> to refer to one of the standard I/O
channels; it must refer to a file that was opened for
writing.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In the first form, if no <tt><em>fileId</em></tt> is specified then it defaults to <tt>stdout</tt>.
<a href="#_puts"><strong><tt>puts</tt></strong></a> normally outputs a newline character after <tt><em>string</em></tt>,
but this feature may be suppressed by specifying the <tt>-nonewline</tt>
switch.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Output to files is buffered internally by Tcl; the <a href="#_flush"><strong><tt>flush</tt></strong></a>
command may be used to force buffered characters to be output.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_pwd">pwd</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>pwd</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns the path name of the current working directory.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_rand">rand</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>rand</strong> <em>?min? ?max?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a random integer between <tt><em>min</em></tt> (defaults to 0) and <tt><em>max</em></tt>
(defaults to the maximum integer).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If only one argument is given, it is interpreted as <tt><em>max</em></tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_range">range</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>range</strong> <em>?start? end ?step?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a list of integers starting at <tt><em>start</em></tt> (defaults to 0)
and ranging up to but not including <tt><em>end</em></tt> in steps of <tt><em>step</em></tt> defaults to 1).</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; range 5
0 1 2 3 4
jim&gt; range 2 5
2 3 4
jim&gt; range 2 10 4
2 6
jim&gt; range 7 4 -2
7 5</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_read">read</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>read</strong> ?<strong>-nonewline</strong>? <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>read</strong> ?<strong>-nonewline</strong>?</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>read</strong> <em>fileId numBytes</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>read</strong> <em>numBytes</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In the first form, all of the remaining bytes are read from the file
given by <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>; they are returned as the result of the command.
If the <tt>-nonewline</tt> switch is specified then the last
character of the file is discarded if it is a newline.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In the second form, the extra argument specifies how many bytes to read;
exactly this many bytes will be read and returned, unless there are fewer than
<tt><em>numBytes</em></tt> bytes left in the file; in this case, all the remaining
bytes are returned.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must be <tt>stdin</tt> or the return value from a previous call
to <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>; it must refer to a file that was opened for reading.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_regexp">regexp</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>regexp ?-nocase? ?-line? ?-indices? ?-start</strong> <em>offset</em>? <strong>?-all? ?-inline? ?--?</strong> <em>exp string ?matchVar? ?subMatchVar subMatchVar ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Determines whether the regular expression <tt><em>exp</em></tt> matches part or
all of <tt><em>string</em></tt> and returns 1 if it does, 0 if it doesn&#8217;t.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See REGULAR EXPRESSIONS above for complete information on the
syntax of <tt><em>exp</em></tt> and how it is matched against <tt><em>string</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If additional arguments are specified after <tt><em>string</em></tt> then they
are treated as the names of variables to use to return
information about which part(s) of <tt><em>string</em></tt> matched <tt><em>exp</em></tt>.
<tt><em>matchVar</em></tt> will be set to the range of <tt><em>string</em></tt> that
matched all of <tt><em>exp</em></tt>. The first <tt><em>subMatchVar</em></tt> will contain
the characters in <tt><em>string</em></tt> that matched the leftmost parenthesized
subexpression within <tt><em>exp</em></tt>, the next <tt><em>subMatchVar</em></tt> will
contain the characters that matched the next parenthesized
subexpression to the right in <tt><em>exp</em></tt>, and so on.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Normally, <tt><em>matchVar</em></tt> and the each <tt><em>subMatchVar</em></tt> are set to hold the
matching characters from <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a>, however see <tt>-indices</tt> and
<tt>-inline</tt> below.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If there are more values for <tt><em>subMatchVar</em></tt> than parenthesized subexpressions
within <tt><em>exp</em></tt>, or if a particular subexpression in <tt><em>exp</em></tt> doesn&#8217;t
match the string (e.g. because it was in a portion of the expression
that wasn&#8217;t matched), then the corresponding <tt><em>subMatchVar</em></tt> will be
set to <tt>"-1 -1"</tt> if <tt>-indices</tt> has been specified or to an empty
string otherwise.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following switches modify the behaviour of <tt><em>regexp</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-nocase</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Causes upper-case and lower-case characters to be treated as
identical during the matching process.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-line</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use newline-sensitive matching. By default, newline
is a completely ordinary character with no special meaning in
either REs or strings. With this flag, <tt>[<sup></tt> bracket expressions
and <tt>.</tt> never match newline, a <tt></sup></tt> anchor matches the null
string after any newline in the string in addition to its normal
function, and the <tt>$</tt> anchor matches the null string before any
newline in the string in addition to its normal function.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-indices</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Changes what is stored in the subMatchVars. Instead of
storing the matching characters from string, each variable
will contain a list of two decimal strings giving the indices
in string of the first and last characters in the matching
range of characters.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-start</strong> <em>offset</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Specifies a character index offset into the string at which to start
matching the regular expression. If <tt>-indices</tt> is
specified, the indices will be indexed starting from the
absolute beginning of the input string. <tt><em>offset</em></tt> will be
constrained to the bounds of the input string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-all</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Causes the regular expression to be matched as many times as possible
in the string, returning the total number of matches found. If this
is specified with match variables, they will contain information
for the last match only.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-inline</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Causes the command to return, as a list, the data that would otherwise
be placed in match variables. When using <tt>-inline</tt>, match variables
may not be specified. If used with <tt>-all</tt>, the list will be concatenated
at each iteration, such that a flat list is always returned. For
each match iteration, the command will append the overall match
data, plus one element for each subexpression in the regular
expression.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>--</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Marks the end of switches. The argument following this one will be
treated as <tt><em>exp</em></tt> even if it starts with a <tt>-</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_regsub">regsub</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>regsub ?-nocase? ?-all? ?-line? ?-start</strong> <em>offset</em>? ?<strong>--</strong>? <em>exp string subSpec ?varName?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command matches the regular expression <tt><em>exp</em></tt> against
<tt><em>string</em></tt> using the rules described in REGULAR EXPRESSIONS
above.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is specified, the commands stores <tt><em>string</em></tt> to <tt><em>varName</em></tt>
with the substitutions detailed below, and returns the number of
substitutions made (normally 1 unless <tt>-all</tt> is specified).
This is 0 if there were no matches.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> is not specified, the substituted string will be returned
instead.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>When copying <tt><em>string</em></tt>, the portion of <tt><em>string</em></tt> that
matched <tt><em>exp</em></tt> is replaced with <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt>.
If <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> contains a <tt>&amp;</tt> or <tt>\0</tt>, then it is replaced
in the substitution with the portion of <tt><em>string</em></tt> that
matched <tt><em>exp</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> contains a <tt>\n</tt>, where <tt><em>n</em></tt> is a digit
between 1 and 9, then it is replaced in the substitution with
the portion of <tt><em>string</em></tt> that matched the <tt><em>n</em></tt>'-th
parenthesized subexpression of <tt><em>exp</em></tt>.
Additional backslashes may be used in <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> to prevent special
interpretation of <tt>&amp;</tt> or <tt>\0</tt> or <tt>\n</tt> or
backslash.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The use of backslashes in <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> tends to interact badly
with the Tcl parser&#8217;s use of backslashes, so it&#8217;s generally
safest to enclose <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> in braces if it includes
backslashes.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following switches modify the behaviour of <tt><em>regsub</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-nocase</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Upper-case characters in <tt><em>string</em></tt> are converted to lower-case
before matching against <tt><em>exp</em></tt>; however, substitutions
specified by <tt><em>subSpec</em></tt> use the original unconverted form
of <tt><em>string</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-all</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
All ranges in <tt><em>string</em></tt> that match <tt><em>exp</em></tt> are found and substitution
is performed for each of these ranges, rather than only the
first. The <tt>&amp;</tt> and <tt>\n</tt> sequences are handled for
each substitution using the information from the corresponding
match.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-line</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use newline-sensitive matching. By default, newline
is a completely ordinary character with no special meaning in
either REs or strings. With this flag, <tt>[<sup></tt> bracket expressions
and <tt>.</tt> never match newline, a <tt></sup></tt> anchor matches the null
string after any newline in the string in addition to its normal
function, and the <tt>$</tt> anchor matches the null string before any
newline in the string in addition to its normal function.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-start</strong> <em>offset</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Specifies a character index offset into the string at which to
start matching the regular expression. <tt><em>offset</em></tt> will be
constrained to the bounds of the input string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>--</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Marks the end of switches. The argument following this one will be
treated as <tt><em>exp</em></tt> even if it starts with a <tt>-</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_ref">ref</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>ref</strong> <em>string tag ?finalizer?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Create a new reference containing <tt><em>string</em></tt> of type <tt><em>tag</em></tt>.
If <tt><em>finalizer</em></tt> is specified, it is a command which will be invoked
when the a garbage collection cycle runs and this reference is
no longer accessible.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The finalizer is invoked as:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>finalizer reference string</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_rename">rename</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>rename</strong> <em>oldName newName</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Rename the command that used to be called <tt><em>oldName</em></tt> so that it
is now called <tt><em>newName</em></tt>. If <tt><em>newName</em></tt> is an empty string
(e.g. {}) then <tt><em>oldName</em></tt> is deleted. The <a href="#_rename"><strong><tt>rename</tt></strong></a> command
returns an empty string as result.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_return">return</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>return</strong> ?<strong>-code</strong> <em>code</em>? ?<strong>-errorinfo</strong> <em>stacktrace</em>? ?<strong>-errorcode</strong> <em>errorcode</em>? ?<strong>-level</strong> <em>n</em>? ?<em>value</em>?</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Return immediately from the current procedure (or top-level command
or <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command), with <tt><em>value</em></tt> as the return value. If <tt><em>value</em></tt>
is not specified, an empty string will be returned as result.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-code</tt> is specified (as either a number or ok, error, break,
continue, signal, return or exit), this code will be used instead
of <tt>JIM_OK</tt>. This is generally useful when implementing flow of control
commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-level</tt> is specified and greater than 1, it has the effect of delaying
the new return code from <tt>-code</tt>. This is useful when rethrowing an error
from <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>. See the implementation of try/catch in tclcompat.tcl for
an example of how this is done.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note: The following options are only used when <tt>-code</tt> is JIM_ERR.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-errorinfo</tt> is specified (as returned from <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>stacktrace</tt>)
it is used to initialize the stacktrace.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt>-errorcode</tt> is specified, it is used to set the global variable $::errorCode.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_scan">scan</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>scan</strong> <em>string format varName1 ?varName2 ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command parses fields from an input string in the same fashion
as the C <em>sscanf</em> procedure. <tt><em>string</em></tt> gives the input to be parsed
and <tt><em>format</em></tt> indicates how to parse it, using <em>%</em> fields as in
<em>sscanf</em>. All of the <em>sscanf</em> options are valid; see the <em>sscanf</em>
man page for details. Each <tt><em>varName</em></tt> gives the name of a variable;
when a field is scanned from <tt><em>string</em></tt>, the result is converted back
into a string and assigned to the corresponding <tt><em>varName</em></tt>. The
only unusual conversion is for <em>%c</em>. For <em>%c</em> conversions a single
character value is converted to a decimal string, which is then
assigned to the corresponding <tt><em>varName</em></tt>; no field width may be
specified for this conversion.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_seek">seek</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>seek</strong> <em>fileId offset ?origin?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>seek</strong> <em>offset ?origin?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Change the current access position for <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>.
The <tt><em>offset</em></tt> and <tt><em>origin</em></tt> arguments specify the position at
which the next read or write will occur for <tt><em>fileId</em></tt>.
<tt><em>offset</em></tt> must be a number (which may be negative) and <tt><em>origin</em></tt>
must be one of the following:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>start</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The new access position will be <tt><em>offset</em></tt> bytes from the start
of the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>current</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The new access position will be <tt><em>offset</em></tt> bytes from the current
access position; a negative <tt><em>offset</em></tt> moves the access position
backwards in the file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>end</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The new access position will be <tt><em>offset</em></tt> bytes from the end of
the file. A negative <tt><em>offset</em></tt> places the access position before
the end-of-file, and a positive <tt><em>offset</em></tt> places the access position
after the end-of-file.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>origin</em></tt> argument defaults to <tt>start</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must have been the return value from a previous call to
<a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>, or it may be <tt>stdin</tt>, <tt>stdout</tt>, or <tt>stderr</tt> to refer to one
of the standard I/O channels.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command returns an empty string.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_set">set</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>set</strong> <em>varName ?value?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns the value of variable <tt><em>varName</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>value</em></tt> is specified, then set the value of <tt><em>varName</em></tt> to <tt><em>value</em></tt>,
creating a new variable if one doesn&#8217;t already exist, and return
its value.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>varName</em></tt> contains an open parenthesis and ends with a
close parenthesis, then it refers to an array element: the characters
before the open parenthesis are the name of the array, and the characters
between the parentheses are the index within the array.
Otherwise <tt><em>varName</em></tt> refers to a scalar variable.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If no procedure is active, then <tt><em>varName</em></tt> refers to a global
variable.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a procedure is active, then <tt><em>varName</em></tt> refers to a parameter
or local variable of the procedure, unless the <tt><em>global</em></tt> command
has been invoked to declare <tt><em>varName</em></tt> to be global.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt>::</tt> prefix may also be used to explicitly reference a variable
in the global scope.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_setref">setref</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>setref</strong> <em>reference string</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Store a new string in <tt><em>reference</em></tt>, replacing the existing string.
The reference must be a valid reference create with the <a href="#_ref"><strong><tt>ref</tt></strong></a>
command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See GARBAGE COLLECTION, REFERENCES, LAMBDA for more detail.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_signal">signal</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Command for signal handling.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See <a href="#_kill"><strong><tt>kill</tt></strong></a> for the different forms which may be used to specify signals.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Commands which return a list of signal names do so using the canonical form:
"<tt>SIGINT SIGTERM</tt>".</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>signal handle</strong> ?<em>signals ...</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If no signals are given, returns a list of all signals which are currently
being handled.
If signals are specified, these are added to the list of signals currently
being handled.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>signal ignore</strong> ?<em>signals ...</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If no signals are given, returns a lists all signals which are currently
being ignored.
If signals are specified, these are added to the list of signals
currently being ignored. These signals are still delivered, but
are not considered by <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-signal</tt> or <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a> <tt>-signal</tt>. Use
<a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>check</tt> to determine which signals have occurred but
been ignored.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>signal default</strong> ?<em>signals ...</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If no signals are given, returns a lists all signals which are currently have
the default behaviour.
If signals are specified, these are added to the list of signals which have
the default behaviour.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>signal check ?-clear?</strong> ?<em>signals ...</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of signals which have been delivered to the process
but are <em>ignored</em>. If signals are specified, only that set of signals will
be checked, otherwise all signals will be checked.
If <tt>-clear</tt> is specified, any signals returned are removed and will not be
returned by subsequent calls to <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>check</tt> unless delivered again.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>signal throw</strong> ?<em>signal</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Raises the given signal, which defaults to <tt>SIGINT</tt> if not specified.
The behaviour is identical to:
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>kill signal [pid]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>handle</tt> and <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>ignore</tt> represent two forms of signal
handling. <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>handle</tt> is used in conjunction with <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> <tt>-signal</tt> or <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a> <tt>-signal</tt>
to immediately abort execution when the signal is delivered. Alternatively, <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>ignore</tt>
is used in conjunction with <a href="#_signal"><strong><tt>signal</tt></strong></a> <tt>check</tt> to handle signal synchronously. Consider the
two examples below.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Prevent a processing from taking too long</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>signal handle SIGALRM
alarm 20
try -signal {
.. possibly long running process ..
alarm 0
} on signal {sig} {
puts stderr "Process took too long"
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Handle SIGHUP to reconfigure:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>signal ignore SIGHUP
while {1} {
... handle configuration/reconfiguration ...
while {[signal check -clear SIGHUP] eq ""} {
... do processing ..
}
# Received SIGHUP, so reconfigure
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_sleep">sleep</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>sleep</strong> <em>seconds</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Pauses for the given number of seconds, which may be a floating
point value less than one to sleep for less than a second, or an
integer to sleep for one or more seconds.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_source">source</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>source</strong> <em>fileName</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Read file <tt><em>fileName</em></tt> and pass the contents to the Tcl interpreter
as a sequence of commands to execute in the normal fashion. The return
value of <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> is the return value of the last command executed
from the file. If an error occurs in executing the contents of the
file, then the <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command will return that error.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> command is invoked from within the file, the remainder of
the file will be skipped and the <a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> command will return
normally with the result from the <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_split">split</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>split</strong> <em>string ?splitChars?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a list created by splitting <tt><em>string</em></tt> at each character
that is in the <tt><em>splitChars</em></tt> argument.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Each element of the result list will consist of the
characters from <tt><em>string</em></tt> between instances of the
characters in <tt><em>splitChars</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Empty list elements will be generated if <tt><em>string</em></tt> contains
adjacent characters in <tt><em>splitChars</em></tt>, or if the first or last
character of <tt><em>string</em></tt> is in <tt><em>splitChars</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>splitChars</em></tt> is an empty string then each character of
<tt><em>string</em></tt> becomes a separate element of the result list.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>splitChars</em></tt> defaults to the standard white-space characters.
For example,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>split "comp.unix.misc" .</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>returns <tt><em>"comp unix misc"</em></tt> and</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>split "Hello world" {}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>returns <tt><em>"H e l l o { } w o r l d"</em></tt>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_stackdump">stackdump</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>stackdump</strong> <em>stacktrace</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Creates a human readable representation of a stack trace.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_stacktrace">stacktrace</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>stacktrace</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a live stack trace as a list of <tt>proc file line proc file line ...</tt>.
Iteratively uses <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>frame</tt> to create the stack trace. This stack trace is in the
same form as produced by <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>stacktrace</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_stackdump"><strong><tt>stackdump</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_string">string</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>string</strong> <em>option arg ?arg ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Perform one of several string operations, depending on <tt><em>option</em></tt>.
The legal options (which may be abbreviated) are:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string bytelength</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the length of the string in bytes. This will return
the same value as <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>length</tt> if UTF-8 support is not enabled,
or if the string is composed entirely of ASCII characters.
See UTF-8 AND UNICODE.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string byterange</strong> <em>string first last</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Like <a href="#_string"><strong><tt>string</tt></strong></a> <tt>range</tt> except works on bytes rather than characters.
These commands are identical if UTF-8 support is not enabled.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string compare ?-nocase?</strong> <em>string1 string2</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Perform a character-by-character comparison of strings <tt><em>string1</em></tt> and
<tt><em>string2</em></tt> in the same way as the C <em>strcmp</em> procedure. Return
-1, 0, or 1, depending on whether <tt><em>string1</em></tt> is lexicographically
less than, equal to, or greater than <tt><em>string2</em></tt>.
Performs a case-insensitive comparison if <tt>-nocase</tt> is specified.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string equal ?-nocase?</strong> <em>string1 string2</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if the strings are equal, or 0 otherwise.
Performs a case-insensitive comparison if <tt>-nocase</tt> is specified.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string first</strong> <em>string1 string2 ?firstIndex?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Search <tt><em>string2</em></tt> for a sequence of characters that exactly match
the characters in <tt><em>string1</em></tt>. If found, return the index of the
first character in the first such match within <tt><em>string2</em></tt>. If not
found, return -1. If <tt><em>firstIndex</em></tt> is specified, matching will start
from <tt><em>firstIndex</em></tt> of <tt><em>string1</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>firstIndex</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string index</strong> <em>string charIndex</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the <tt><em>charIndex</em></tt><em>th character of the <tt>'string</em></tt>
argument. A <tt><em>charIndex</em></tt> of 0 corresponds to the first
character of the string.
If <tt><em>charIndex</em></tt> is less than 0 or greater than
or equal to the length of the string then an empty string is
returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>charIndex</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string is</strong> <em>class</em> ?<strong>-strict</strong>? <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if <tt><em>string</em></tt> is a valid member of the specified character
class, otherwise returns 0. If <tt>-strict</tt> is specified, then an
empty string returns 0, otherwise an empty string will return 1
on any class. The following character classes are recognized
(the class name can be abbreviated):
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>alnum</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any alphabet or digit character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>alpha</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any alphabet character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>ascii</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any character with a value less than 128 (those that are in the 7-bit ascii range).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>control</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any control character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>digit</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any digit character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>double</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any of the valid forms for a double in Tcl, with optional surrounding whitespace.
In case of under/overflow in the value, 0 is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>graph</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any printing character, except space.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>integer</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any of the valid string formats for an integer value in Tcl, with optional surrounding whitespace.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>lower</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any lower case alphabet character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>print</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any printing character, including space.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>punct</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any punctuation character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>space</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any space character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>upper</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any upper case alphabet character.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>xdigit</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Any hexadecimal digit character ([0-9A-Fa-f]).
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Note that string classification does <tt><em>not</em></tt> respect UTF-8. See UTF-8 AND UNICODE
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string last</strong> <em>string1 string2 ?lastIndex?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Search <tt><em>string2</em></tt> for a sequence of characters that exactly match
the characters in <tt><em>string1</em></tt>. If found, return the index of the
first character in the last such match within <tt><em>string2</em></tt>. If there
is no match, then return -1. If <tt><em>lastIndex</em></tt> is specified, only characters
up to <tt><em>lastIndex</em></tt> of <tt><em>string2</em></tt> will be considered in the match.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>lastIndex</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string length</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a decimal string giving the number of characters in <tt><em>string</em></tt>.
If UTF-8 support is enabled, this may be different than the number of bytes.
See UTF-8 AND UNICODE
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string map ?-nocase?</strong> <em>mapping string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Replaces substrings in <tt><em>string</em></tt> based on the key-value pairs in
<tt><em>mapping</em></tt>, which is a list of <tt>key value key value ...</tt> as in the form
returned by <a href="#_array"><strong><tt>array</tt></strong></a> <tt>get</tt>. Each instance of a key in the string will be
replaced with its corresponding value. If <tt>-nocase</tt> is specified, then
matching is done without regard to case differences. Both key and value may
be multiple characters. Replacement is done in an ordered manner, so the
key appearing first in the list will be checked first, and so on. <tt><em>string</em></tt> is
only iterated over once, so earlier key replacements will have no affect for
later key matches. For example,
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>string map {abc 1 ab 2 a 3 1 0} 1abcaababcabababc</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
will return the string <tt>01321221</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Note that if an earlier key is a prefix of a later one, it will completely mask the later
one. So if the previous example is reordered like this,
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>string map {1 0 ab 2 a 3 abc 1} 1abcaababcabababc</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
it will return the string <tt>02c322c222c</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string match ?-nocase?</strong> <em>pattern string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
See if <tt><em>pattern</em></tt> matches <tt><em>string</em></tt>; return 1 if it does, 0
if it doesn&#8217;t. Matching is done in a fashion similar to that
used by the C-shell. For the two strings to match, their contents
must be identical except that the following special sequences
may appear in <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>:
</p>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>*</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Matches any sequence of characters in <tt><em>string</em></tt>,
including a null string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Matches any single character in <tt><em>string</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>[<em>chars</em>]</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Matches any character in the set given by <tt><em>chars</em></tt>.
If a sequence of the form <tt><em>x-y</em></tt> appears in <tt><em>chars</em></tt>,
then any character between <tt><em>x</em></tt> and <tt><em>y</em></tt>, inclusive,
will match.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>\x</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Matches the single character <tt><em>x</em></tt>. This provides a way of
avoiding the special interpretation of the characters <tt>\*?[]</tt>
in <tt><em>pattern</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Performs a case-insensitive comparison if <tt>-nocase</tt> is specified.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string range</strong> <em>string first last</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a range of consecutive characters from <tt><em>string</em></tt>, starting
with the character whose index is <tt><em>first</em></tt> and ending with the
character whose index is <tt><em>last</em></tt>. An index of 0 refers to the
first character of the string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
See STRING AND LIST INDEX SPECIFICATIONS for all allowed forms for <tt><em>first</em></tt> and <tt><em>last</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is less than zero then it is treated as if it were zero, and
if <tt><em>last</em></tt> is greater than or equal to the length of the string then
it is treated as if it were <tt>end</tt>. If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is greater than
<tt><em>last</em></tt> then an empty string is returned.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string repeat</strong> <em>string count</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a new string consisting of <tt><em>string</em></tt> repeated <tt><em>count</em></tt> times.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string replace</strong> <em>string first last ?newstring?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Removes a range of consecutive characters from <tt><em>string</em></tt>, starting
with the character whose index is <tt><em>first</em></tt> and ending with the
character whose index is <tt><em>last</em></tt>. If <tt><em>newstring</em></tt> is specified,
then it is placed in the removed character range. If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is
less than zero then it is treated as if it were zero, and if <tt><em>last</em></tt>
is greater than or equal to the length of the string then it is
treated as if it were <tt>end</tt>. If <tt><em>first</em></tt> is greater than <tt><em>last</em></tt>
or the length of the initial string, or <tt><em>last</em></tt> is less than 0,
then the initial string is returned untouched.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string reverse</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a string that is the same length as <tt><em>string</em></tt> but
with its characters in the reverse order.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string tolower</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that all upper case
letters have been converted to lower case.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string totitle</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that the first character
is converted to title case (or upper case if there is no UTF-8 titlecase variant)
and all remaining characters have been converted to lower case.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string toupper</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that all lower case
letters have been converted to upper case.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string trim</strong> <em>string ?chars?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that any leading
or trailing characters from the set given by <tt><em>chars</em></tt> are
removed.
If <tt><em>chars</em></tt> is not specified then white space is removed
(spaces, tabs, newlines, and carriage returns).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string trimleft</strong> <em>string ?chars?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that any
leading characters from the set given by <tt><em>chars</em></tt> are
removed.
If <tt><em>chars</em></tt> is not specified then white space is removed
(spaces, tabs, newlines, and carriage returns).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>string trimright</strong> <em>string ?chars?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a value equal to <tt><em>string</em></tt> except that any
trailing characters from the set given by <tt><em>chars</em></tt> are
removed.
If <tt><em>chars</em></tt> is not specified then white space is removed
(spaces, tabs, newlines, and carriage returns).
Null characters are always removed.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_subst">subst</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>subst ?-nobackslashes? ?-nocommands? ?-novariables?</strong> <em>string</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command performs variable substitutions, command substitutions,
and backslash substitutions on its string argument and returns the
fully-substituted result. The substitutions are performed in exactly
the same way as for Tcl commands. As a result, the string argument
is actually substituted twice, once by the Tcl parser in the usual
fashion for Tcl commands, and again by the subst command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If any of the <tt>-nobackslashes</tt>, <tt>-nocommands</tt>, or <tt>-novariables</tt> are
specified, then the corresponding substitutions are not performed.
For example, if <tt>-nocommands</tt> is specified, no command substitution
is performed: open and close brackets are treated as ordinary
characters with no special interpretation.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><strong>Note</strong>: when it performs its substitutions, subst does not give any
special treatment to double quotes or curly braces. For example,
the following script returns <tt>xyz {44}</tt>, not <tt>xyz {$a}</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set a 44
subst {xyz {$a}}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_switch">switch</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>switch</strong> <em>?options? string pattern body ?pattern body ...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>switch</strong> <em>?options? string {pattern body ?pattern body ...?}</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> command matches its string argument against each of
the pattern arguments in order. As soon as it finds a pattern that
matches string it evaluates the following body and returns the
result of that evaluation. If the last pattern argument is default
then it matches anything. If no pattern argument matches string and
no default is given, then the <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> command returns an empty string.
If the initial arguments to switch start with - then they are treated
as options. The following options are currently supported:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-exact</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use exact matching when comparing string to a
pattern. This is the default.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-glob</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
When matching string to the patterns, use glob-style
matching (i.e. the same as implemented by the string
match command).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-regexp</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
When matching string to the patterns, use regular
expression matching (i.e. the same as implemented
by the regexp command).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-command <em>commandname</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
When matching string to the patterns, use the given command, which
must be a single word. The command is invoked as
<em>commandname pattern string</em>, or <em>commandname -nocase pattern string</em>
and must return 1 if matched, or 0 if not.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>--</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Marks the end of options. The argument following
this one will be treated as string even if it starts
with a <tt>-</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Two syntaxes are provided for the pattern and body arguments. The
first uses a separate argument for each of the patterns and commands;
this form is convenient if substitutions are desired on some of the
patterns or commands. The second form places all of the patterns
and commands together into a single argument; the argument must
have proper list structure, with the elements of the list being the
patterns and commands. The second form makes it easy to construct
multi-line <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> commands, since the braces around the whole list
make it unnecessary to include a backslash at the end of each line.
Since the pattern arguments are in braces in the second form, no
command or variable substitutions are performed on them; this makes
the behaviour of the second form different than the first form in
some cases.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a body is specified as <tt>-</tt> it means that the body for the next
pattern should also be used as the body for this pattern (if the
next pattern also has a body of <tt>-</tt> then the body after that is
used, and so on). This feature makes it possible to share a single
body among several patterns.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Below are some examples of <a href="#_switch"><strong><tt>switch</tt></strong></a> commands:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>switch abc a - b {format 1} abc {format 2} default {format 3}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return 2,</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>switch -regexp aaab {
^a.*b$ -
b {format 1}
a* {format 2}
default {format 3}
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return 1, and</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>switch xyz {
a -
b {format 1}
a* {format 2}
default {format 3}
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>will return 3.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_tailcall">tailcall</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>tailcall</strong> <em>cmd ?arg...?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_tailcall"><strong><tt>tailcall</tt></strong></a> command provides an optimised way of invoking a command whilst replacing
the current call frame. This is similar to <em>exec</em> in Bourne Shell.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following are identical except the first immediately replaces the current call frame.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>tailcall a b c</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>return [uplevel 1 [list a b c]]</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_tailcall"><strong><tt>tailcall</tt></strong></a> is useful as a dispatch mechanism:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>proc a {cmd args} {
tailcall sub_$cmd {*}$args
}
proc sub_cmd1 ...
proc sub_cmd2 ...</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_tell">tell</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>tell</strong> <em>fileId</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em> <strong>tell</strong></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Returns a decimal string giving the current access position in
<tt><em>fileId</em></tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>fileId</em></tt> must have been the return value from a previous call to
<a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a>, or it may be <tt>stdin</tt>, <tt>stdout</tt>, or <tt>stderr</tt> to refer to one
of the standard I/O channels.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_throw">throw</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>throw</strong> <em>code ?msg?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command throws an exception (return) code along with an optional message.
This command is mostly for convenient usage with <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The command <tt>throw break</tt> is equivalent to <tt>break</tt>.
The command <tt>throw 20 message</tt> can be caught with an <tt>on 20 ...</tt> clause to <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_time">time</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>time</strong> <em>command ?count?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command will call the Tcl interpreter <tt><em>count</em></tt>
times to execute <tt><em>command</em></tt> (or once if <tt><em>count</em></tt> isn&#8217;t
specified). It will then return a string of the form</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>503 microseconds per iteration</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>which indicates the average amount of time required per iteration,
in microseconds.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Time is measured in elapsed time, not CPU time.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_try">try</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>try</strong> <em>?catchopts? tryscript</em> ?<strong>on</strong> <em>returncodes {?resultvar? ?optsvar?} handlerscript ...</em>? ?<strong>finally</strong> <em>finalscript</em>?</tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a> command is provided as a convenience for exception handling.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This interpeter first evaluates <tt><em>tryscript</em></tt> under the effect of the catch
options <tt><em>catchopts</em></tt> (e.g. <tt>-signal -noexit --</tt>, see <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>It then evaluates the script for the first matching <em>on</em> handler
(there many be zero or more) based on the return code from the <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a>
section. For example a normal <tt>JIM_ERR</tt> error will be matched by
an <em>on error</em> handler.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Finally, any <tt><em>finalscript</em></tt> is evaluated.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The result of this command is the result of <tt><em>tryscript</em></tt>, except in the
case where an exception occurs in a matching <em>on</em> handler script or the <em>finally</em> script,
in which case the result is this new exception.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The specified <tt><em>returncodes</em></tt> is a list of return codes either as names (<em>ok</em>, <em>error</em>, <em>break</em>, etc.)
or as integers.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>resultvar</em></tt> and <tt><em>optsvar</em></tt> are specified, they are set as for <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> before evaluating
the matching handler.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set f [open input]
try -signal {
process $f
} on {continue break} {} {
error "Unexpected break/continue"
} on error {msg opts} {
puts "Dealing with error"
return {*}$opts $msg
} on signal sig {
puts "Got signal: $sig"
} finally {
$f close
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If break, continue or error are raised, they are dealt with by the matching
handler.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In any case, the file will be closed via the <em>finally</em> clause.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See also <a href="#_throw"><strong><tt>throw</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_error"><strong><tt>error</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_unknown">unknown</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>unknown</strong> <em>cmdName ?arg arg &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command doesn&#8217;t actually exist as part of Tcl, but Tcl will
invoke it if it does exist.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the Tcl interpreter encounters a command name for which there
is not a defined command, then Tcl checks for the existence of
a command named <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If there is no such command, then the interpreter returns an
error.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If the <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> command exists, then it is invoked with
arguments consisting of the fully-substituted name and arguments
for the original non-existent command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> command typically does things like searching
through library directories for a command procedure with the name
<tt><em>cmdName</em></tt>, or expanding abbreviated command names to full-length,
or automatically executing unknown commands as UNIX sub-processes.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>In some cases (such as expanding abbreviations) <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> will
change the original command slightly and then (re-)execute it.
The result of the <a href="#_unknown"><strong><tt>unknown</tt></strong></a> command is used as the result for
the original non-existent command.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_unset">unset</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>unset ?-nocomplain? ?--?</strong> <em>?name name &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Remove variables.
Each <tt><em>name</em></tt> is a variable name, specified in any of the
ways acceptable to the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <tt><em>name</em></tt> refers to an element of an array, then that
element is removed without affecting the rest of the array.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a <tt><em>name</em></tt> consists of an array name with no parenthesized
index, then the entire array is deleted.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_unset"><strong><tt>unset</tt></strong></a> command returns an empty string as result.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>An error occurs if any of the variables doesn&#8217;t exist, unless <em>-nocomplain</em>
is specified. The <em>--</em> argument may be specified to stop option processing
in case the variable name may be <em>-nocomplain</em>.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_upcall">upcall</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>upcall</strong> <em>command ?args &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>May be used from within a proc defined as <a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a> <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a> in order to call
the previous, hidden version of the same command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If there is no previous definition of the command, an error is returned.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_uplevel">uplevel</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>uplevel</strong> <em>?level? command ?command &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>All of the <tt><em>command</em></tt> arguments are concatenated as if they had
been passed to <a href="#_concat"><strong><tt>concat</tt></strong></a>; the result is then evaluated in the
variable context indicated by <tt><em>level</em></tt>. <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> returns
the result of that evaluation. If <tt><em>level</em></tt> is an integer, then
it gives a distance (up the procedure calling stack) to move before
executing the command. If <tt><em>level</em></tt> consists of <tt>#</tt> followed by
a number then the number gives an absolute level number. If <tt><em>level</em></tt>
is omitted then it defaults to <tt>1</tt>. <tt><em>level</em></tt> cannot be
defaulted if the first <tt><em>command</em></tt> argument starts with a digit or <tt>#</tt>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For example, suppose that procedure <em>a</em> was invoked
from top-level, and that it called <em>b</em>, and that <em>b</em> called <em>c</em>.
Suppose that <em>c</em> invokes the <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> command. If <tt><em>level</em></tt>
is <tt>1</tt> or <tt>#2</tt> or omitted, then the command will be executed
in the variable context of <em>b</em>. If <tt><em>level</em></tt> is <tt>2</tt> or <tt>#1</tt>
then the command will be executed in the variable context of <em>a</em>.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If <tt><em>level</em></tt> is <em>3</em> or <tt>#0</tt> then the command will be executed
at top-level (only global variables will be visible).
The <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> command causes the invoking procedure to disappear
from the procedure calling stack while the command is being executed.
In the above example, suppose <em>c</em> invokes the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>uplevel 1 {set x 43; d}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>where <em>d</em> is another Tcl procedure. The <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command will
modify the variable <em>x</em> in <em>b&#8217;s context, and 'd</em> will execute
at level 3, as if called from <em>b</em>. If it in turn executes
the command</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>uplevel {set x 42}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>then the <a href="#_set"><strong><tt>set</tt></strong></a> command will modify the same variable <em>x</em> in <em>b&#8217;s
context: the procedure 'c</em> does not appear to be on the call stack
when <em>d</em> is executing. The command <a href="#_info"><strong><tt>info</tt></strong></a> <tt>level</tt> may
be used to obtain the level of the current procedure.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> makes it possible to implement new control
constructs as Tcl procedures (for example, <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a> could
be used to implement the <a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a> construct as a Tcl procedure).</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_upvar">upvar</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>upvar</strong> <em>?level? otherVar myVar ?otherVar myVar &#8230;?</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command arranges for one or more local variables in the current
procedure to refer to variables in an enclosing procedure call or
to global variables.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><em>level</em></tt> may have any of the forms permitted for the <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a>
command, and may be omitted if the first letter of the first <tt><em>otherVar</em></tt>
isn&#8217;t <tt>#</tt> or a digit (it defaults to <em>1</em>).</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For each <tt><em>otherVar</em></tt> argument, <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> makes the variable
by that name in the procedure frame given by <tt><em>level</em></tt> (or at
global level, if <tt><em>level</em></tt> is <tt>#0</tt>) accessible
in the current procedure by the name given in the corresponding
<tt><em>myVar</em></tt> argument.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The variable named by <tt><em>otherVar</em></tt> need not exist at the time of the
call; it will be created the first time <tt><em>myVar</em></tt> is referenced, just like
an ordinary variable.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> may only be invoked from within procedures.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> returns an empty string.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> command simplifies the implementation of call-by-name
procedure calling and also makes it easier to build new control constructs
as Tcl procedures.
For example, consider the following procedure:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>proc add2 name {
upvar $name x
set x [expr $x+2]
}</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p><em>add2</em> is invoked with an argument giving the name of a variable,
and it adds two to the value of that variable.
Although <em>add2</em> could have been implemented using <a href="#_uplevel"><strong><tt>uplevel</tt></strong></a>
instead of <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_upvar"><strong><tt>upvar</tt></strong></a> makes it simpler for <em>add2</em>
to access the variable in the caller&#8217;s procedure frame.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_while">while</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>while</strong> <em>test body</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <tt><em>while</em></tt> command evaluates <tt><em>test</em></tt> as an expression
(in the same way that <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a> evaluates its argument).
The value of the expression must be numeric; if it is non-zero
then <tt><em>body</em></tt> is executed by passing it to the Tcl interpreter.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Once <tt><em>body</em></tt> has been executed then <tt><em>test</em></tt> is evaluated
again, and the process repeats until eventually <tt><em>test</em></tt>
evaluates to a zero numeric value. <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a>
commands may be executed inside <tt><em>body</em></tt> to terminate the current
iteration of the loop, and <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a>
commands may be executed inside <tt><em>body</em></tt> to cause immediate
termination of the <a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a> command.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The <a href="#_while"><strong><tt>while</tt></strong></a> command always returns an empty string.</p></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_optional_extensions">OPTIONAL-EXTENSIONS</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following extensions may or may not be available depending upon
what options were selected when Jim Tcl was built.</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="cmd_1">posix: os.fork, os.wait, os.gethostname, os.getids, os.uptime</h3>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>os.fork</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Invokes <em>fork(2)</em> and returns the result.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>os.wait -nohang</strong> <em>pid</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Invokes waitpid(2), with WNOHANG if <tt>-nohang</tt> is specified.
Returns a list of 3 elements.
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>{0 none 0} if -nohang is specified, and the process is still alive.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>{-1 error &lt;error-description&gt;} if the process does not exist or has already been waited for.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>{&lt;pid&gt; exit &lt;exit-status&gt;} if the process exited normally.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>{&lt;pid&gt; signal &lt;signal-number&gt;} if the process terminated on a signal.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>{&lt;pid&gt; other 0} otherwise (core dump, stopped, continued, etc.)</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>os.gethostname</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Invokes <em>gethostname(3)</em> and returns the result.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>os.getids</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the various user/group ids for the current process.
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>jim&gt; os.getids
uid 1000 euid 1000 gid 100 egid 100</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>os.uptime</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the number of seconds since system boot. See description of <em>uptime</em> in <em>sysinfo(2)</em>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_ansi_i_o_aio_and_eventloop_api">ANSI I/O (aio) and EVENTLOOP API</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>Jim provides an alternative object-based API for I/O.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See <a href="#_open"><strong><tt>open</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a> for commands which return an I/O handle.</p></div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_aio">aio</h3>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>read ?-nonewline?</strong> <em>?len?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Read and return bytes from the stream. To eof if no len.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>gets</strong> <em>?var?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Read one line and return it or store it in the var
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>puts ?-nonewline?</strong> <em>str</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Write the string, with newline unless -nonewline
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>copyto</strong> <em>tofd ?size?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Copy bytes to the file descriptor <tt><em>tofd</em></tt>. If <tt><em>size</em></tt> is specified, at most
that many bytes will be copied. Otherwise copying continues until the end
of the input file. Returns the number of bytes actually copied.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>flush</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Flush the stream
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>filename</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the original filename associated with the handle.
Handles returned by <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a> give the socket type instead of a filename.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>eof</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if stream is at eof
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>close</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Closes the stream
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>seek</strong> <em>offset</em> <strong>?start|current|end?</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Seeks in the stream (default <em>current</em>)
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>tell</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the current seek position
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>filename</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the original filename used when opening the file.
If the handle was returned from <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a>, the type of the
handle is returned instead.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>ndelay ?0|1?</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Set O_NDELAY (if arg). Returns current/new setting.
Note that in general ANSI I/O interacts badly with non-blocking I/O.
Use with care.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>buffering none|line|full</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sets the buffering mode of the stream.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>accept</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Server socket only: Accept a connection and return stream
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>sendto</strong> <em>str ?hostname:?port</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sends the string, <tt><em>str</em></tt>, to the given address via the socket using sendto(2).
This is intended for udp sockets and may give an error or behave in unintended
ways for other handle types.
Returns the number of bytes written.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>recvfrom</strong> <em>maxlen ?addrvar?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Receives a message from the handle via recvfrom(2) and returns it.
At most <tt><em>maxlen</em></tt> bytes are read.
If <tt><em>addrvar</em></tt> is specified, the sending address of the message is stored in
the named variable in the form <em>addr:port</em>. See <a href="#_socket"><strong><tt>socket</tt></strong></a> for details.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_fconfigure">fconfigure</h3>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>fconfigure</strong> <em>handle</em> <strong>?-blocking 0|1? ?-buffering noneline|full? ?-translation</strong> <em>mode</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
For compatibility with Tcl, a limited form of the <a href="#_fconfigure"><strong><tt>fconfigure</tt></strong></a>
command is supported.
</p>
<div class="ulist"><ul>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_fconfigure"><strong><tt>fconfigure</tt></strong></a> <tt>... -blocking</tt> maps to <a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a> <tt>ndelay</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_fconfigure"><strong><tt>fconfigure</tt></strong></a> <tt>... -buffering</tt> maps to <a href="#_aio"><strong><tt>aio</tt></strong></a> <tt>buffering</tt>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_fconfigure"><strong><tt>fconfigure</tt></strong></a> <tt>... -translation</tt> is accepted but ignored
</p>
</li>
</ul></div>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="cmd_2">eventloop: after, vwait, update</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following commands allow a script to be invoked when the given condition occurs.
If no script is given, returns the current script. If the given script is the empty, the
handler is removed.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>readable</strong> <em>?readable-script?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sets or returns the script for when the socket is readable.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>writable</strong> <em>?writable-script?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sets or returns the script for when the socket is writable.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$handle <strong>onexception</strong> <em>?exception-script?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sets or returns the script for when when oob data received.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>For compatibility with <em>Tcl</em>, these may be prefixed with <tt>fileevent</tt>. e.g.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
<tt>fileevent $handle <strong>readable</strong> <em>...</em></tt>
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Time-based execution is also available via the eventloop API.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>after</strong> <em>ms</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Sleeps for the given number of milliseconds. No events are
processed during this time.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>after</strong> <em>ms</em>|<strong>idle</strong> script ?script ...?'</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The scripts are concatenated and executed after the given
number of milliseconds have elapsed. If <em>idle</em> is specified,
the script will run the next time the event loop is processed
with <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>vwait</tt></strong></a> or <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>update</tt></strong></a>. The script is only run once and
then removed. Returns an event id.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>after cancel</strong> <em>id|command</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Cancels an <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>after</tt></strong></a> event with the given event id or matching
command (script). Returns the number of milliseconds
remaining until the event would have fired. Returns the
empty string if no matching event is found.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>after info</strong> <em>?id?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>id</em></tt> is not given, returns a list of current <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>after</tt></strong></a>
events. If <tt><em>id</em></tt> is given, returns a list containing the
associated script and either <em>timer</em> or <em>idle</em> to indicated
the type of the event. An error occurs if <tt><em>id</em></tt> does not
match an event.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>vwait</strong> <em>variable</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A call to <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>vwait</tt></strong></a> is enters the eventloop. <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>vwait</tt></strong></a> processes
events until the named (global) variable changes or all
event handlers are removed. The variable need not exist
beforehand. If there are no event handlers defined, <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>vwait</tt></strong></a>
returns immediately.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>update ?idletasks?</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A call to <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>update</tt></strong></a> enters the eventloop to process expired events, but
no new events. If <em>idletasks</em> is specified, only expired time events are handled,
not file events.
Returns once handlers have been run for all expired events.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Scripts are executed at the global scope. If an error occurs during a handler script,
an attempt is made to call (the user-defined command) <tt>bgerror</tt> with the details of the error.
If the <tt>bgerror</tt> commands does not exist, it is printed to stderr instead.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a file event handler script generates an error, the handler is automatically removed
to prevent infinite errors. (A time event handler is always removed after execution).</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>bgerror</strong> <em>error</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Called when an event handler script generates an error.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_socket">socket</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Various socket types may be created.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket unix</strong> <em>path</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A unix domain socket client.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket unix.server</strong> <em>path</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A unix domain socket server.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket ?-ipv6? stream</strong> <em>addr:port</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A TCP socket client.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket ?-ipv6? stream.server</strong> <em>?addr:?port</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A TCP socket server (<tt><em>addr</em></tt> defaults to <tt>0.0.0.0</tt> for IPv4 or <tt>[::]</tt> for IPv6).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket ?-ipv6? dgram</strong> ?<em>addr:port</em>?</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A UDP socket client. If the address is not specified,
the client socket will be unbound and <em>sendto</em> must be used
to indicated the destination.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket ?-ipv6? dgram.server</strong> <em>addr:port</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A UDP socket server.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>socket pipe</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
A pipe. Note that unlike all other socket types, this command returns
a list of two channels: {read write}
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command creates a socket connected (client) or bound (server) to the given
address.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The returned value is channel and may generally be used with the various file I/O
commands (gets, puts, read, etc.), either as object-based syntax or Tcl-compatible syntax.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set f [socket stream www.google.com:80]
aio.sockstream1
$f puts -nonewline "GET / HTTP/1.0\r\n\r\n"
$f gets
HTTP/1.0 302 Found
$f close</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Server sockets, however support only <em>accept</em>, which is most useful in conjunction with
the EVENTLOOP API.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>set f [socket stream.server 80]
$f readable {
set client [$f accept]
$client gets $buf
...
$client puts -nonewline "HTTP/1.1 404 Not found\r\n"
$client close
}
vwait done</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The address, <tt><em>addr</em></tt>, can be given in one of the following forms:</p></div>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
For IPv4 socket types, an IPv4 address such as 192.168.1.1
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
For IPv6 socket types, an IPv6 address such as [fe80::1234] or [::]
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
A hostname
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that on many systems, listening on an IPv6 address such as [::] will
also accept requests via IPv4.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Where a hostname is specified, the <tt><em>first</em></tt> returned address is used
which matches the socket type is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The special type <em>pipe</em> isn&#8217;t really a socket.</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>lassign [socket pipe] r w</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt># Must close $w after exec
exec ps &gt;@$w &amp;
$w close</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>$r readable ...</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_syslog">syslog</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p><tt><strong>syslog</strong> <em>?options? ?priority? message</em></tt></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>This command sends message to system syslog facility with given
priority. Valid priorities are:</p></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>emerg, alert, crit, err, error, warning, notice, info, debug</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>If a message is specified, but no priority is specified, then a
priority of info is used.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>By default, facility user is used and the value of global tcl variable
argv0 is used as ident string. However, any of the following options
may be specified before priority to control these parameters:</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-facility</strong> <em>value</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use specified facility instead of user. The following
values for facility are recognized:
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>authpriv, cron, daemon, kernel, lpr, mail, news, syslog, user,
uucp, local0-local7</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-ident</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use given string instead of argv0 variable for ident string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>-options</strong> <em>integer</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Set syslog options such as <tt>LOG_CONS</tt>, <tt>LOG_NDELAY</tt>. You should
use numeric values of those from your system syslog.h file,
because I haven&#8217;t got time to implement yet another hash
table.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="cmd_3">pack: pack, unpack</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional <em>pack</em> extension provides commands to encode and decode binary strings.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>pack</strong> <em>varName value</em> <strong>-intle|-intbe|-str</strong> <em>bitwidth ?bitoffset?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Packs the binary representation of <tt><em>value</em></tt> into the variable
<tt><em>varName</em></tt>. The value is packed according to the given type
(integer/string, big-endian/little-endian), width and bit offset.
The variable is created if necessary (like <a href="#_append"><strong><tt>append</tt></strong></a>).
Ihe variable is expanded if necessary.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>unpack</strong> <em>binvalue</em> <strong>-intbe|-intle|-uintbe|-uintle|-str</strong> <em>bitpos bitwidth</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Unpacks bits from <tt><em>binvalue</em></tt> at bit position <tt><em>bitpos</em></tt> and with <tt><em>bitwidth</em></tt>.
Interprets the value according to the type (integer/string, big-endian/little-endian
and signed/unsigned) and returns it. For integer types, <tt><em>bitwidth</em></tt>
may be up to the size of a Jim Tcl integer (typically 64 bits). For the string type,
both the width and the offset must be on a byte boundary (multiple of 8). Attempting to
access outside the length of the value will return 0 for integer types or the empty string
for the string type.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_binary">binary</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional, pure-Tcl <em>binary</em> extension provides the Tcl-compatible <a href="#_binary"><strong><tt>binary</tt></strong></a> <tt>scan</tt> and <a href="#_binary"><strong><tt>binary</tt></strong></a> <tt>format</tt>
commands based on the low-level <a href="#cmd_3"><strong><tt>pack</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#cmd_3"><strong><tt>unpack</tt></strong></a> commands.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the Tcl documentation at: <a href="http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.5/TclCmd/binary.htm">http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.5/TclCmd/binary.htm</a></p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Note that packing and unpacking of floating point values is not supported.</p></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="cmd_4">oo: class, super</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional, pure-Tcl <em>oo</em> extension provides object-oriented (OO) support for Jim Tcl.</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>See the online documentation (<a href="http://jim.berlios.de/documentation/oo/">http://jim.berlios.de/documentation/oo/</a>) for more details.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>class</strong> <em>classname ?baseclasses? classvars</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Create a new class, <tt><em>classname</em></tt>, with the given dictionary
(<tt><em>classvars</em></tt>) as class variables. These are the initial variables
which all newly created objects of this class are initialised with.
If a list of baseclasses is given, methods and instance variables
are inherited.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>super</strong> <em>method ?args ...?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
From within a method, invokes the given method on the base class.
Note that this will only call the last baseclass given.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_tree">tree</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional, pure-Tcl <em>tree</em> extension implements an OO, general purpose tree structure
similar to that provided by tcllib ::struct::tree (<a href="http://tcllib.sourceforge.net/doc/struct_tree.html">http://tcllib.sourceforge.net/doc/struct_tree.html</a>)</p></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>A tree is a collection of nodes, where each node (except the root node) has a single parent
and zero or more child nodes (ordered), as well as zero or more attribute/value pairs.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tree</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Creates and returns a new tree object with a single node named "root".
All operations on the tree are invoked through this object.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>destroy</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Destroy the tree and all it&#8217;s nodes. (Note that the the tree will also
be automatically garbage collected once it goes out of scope).
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>set</strong> <em>nodename key value</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Set the value for the given attribute key.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>lappend</strong> <em>nodename key value ...</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Append to the (list) value(s) for the given attribute key, or set if not yet set.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>keyexists</strong> <em>nodename key</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns 1 if the given attribute key exists.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>get</strong> <em>nodename key</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the value associated with the given attribute key.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>getall</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the entire attribute dictionary associated with the given key.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>depth</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the depth of the given node. The depth of "root" is 0.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>parent</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the node name of the parent node, or "" for the root node.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>numchildren</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the number of child nodes.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>children</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of the child nodes.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>next</strong> <em>nodename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the next sibling node, or "" if none.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>insert</strong> <em>nodename ?index?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Add a new child node to the given node. The index is a list index
such as <tt>3</tt> or <tt>end-2</tt>. The default index is <tt>end</tt>.
Returns the name of the newly added node.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>walk</strong> <em>nodename</em> <strong>dfs|bfs</strong> {<em>actionvar nodevar</em>} <em>script</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Walks the tree starting from the given node, either breadth first (<tt>bfs</tt>)
depth first (<tt>dfs</tt>).
The value <tt>"enter"</tt> or <tt>"exit"</tt> is stored in variable <tt><em>actionvar</em></tt>.
The name of each node is stored in <tt><em>nodevar</em></tt>.
The script is evaluated twice for each node, on entry and exit.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>$tree <strong>dump</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Dumps the tree contents to stdout
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_tcl_prefix">tcl::prefix</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional tclprefix extension provides the Tcl8.6-compatible <em>tcl::prefix</em> command
(<a href="http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.6/TclCmd/prefix.htm">http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.6/TclCmd/prefix.htm</a>) for matching strings against a table
of possible values (typically commands or options).</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tcl::prefix all</strong> <em>table string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns a list of all elements in <tt><em>table</em></tt> that begin with the prefix <tt><em>string</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tcl::prefix longest</strong> <em>table string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the longest common prefix of all elements in <tt><em>table</em></tt> that begin with the prefix <tt><em>string</em></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tcl::prefix match</strong> <em>?options? table string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If <tt><em>string</em></tt> equals one element in <tt><em>table</em></tt> or is a prefix to
exactly one element, the matched element is returned. If not, the
result depends on the <tt>-error</tt> option.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-exact</tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Accept only exact matches.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-message <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Use <tt><em>string</em></tt> in the error message at a mismatch. Default is "option".
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt>-error <em>options</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The options are used when no match is found. If <tt><em>options</em></tt> is
empty, no error is generated and an empty string is returned.
Otherwise the options are used as return options when
generating the error message. The default corresponds to
setting <tt>-level 0</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_history">history</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The optional history extension provides script access to the command line editing
and history support available in <em>jimsh</em>. See <em>examples/jtclsh.tcl</em> for an example.
Note: if line editing support is not available, <a href="#_history"><strong><tt>history</tt></strong></a> <tt>getline</tt> acts like <a href="#_gets"><strong><tt>gets</tt></strong></a> and
the remaining subcommands do nothing.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>history load</strong> <em>filename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Load history from a (text) file. If the file does not exist or is not readable,
it is ignored.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>history getline</strong> <em>prompt ?varname?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Displays the given prompt and allows a line to be entered. Similarly to <a href="#_gets"><strong><tt>gets</tt></strong></a>,
if <tt><em>varname</em></tt> is given, it receives the line and the length of the line is returned,
or -1 on EOF. If <tt><em>varname</em></tt> is not given, the line is returned directly.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>history add</strong> <em>line</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Adds the given line to the history buffer.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>history save</strong> <em>filename</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Saves the current history buffer to the given file.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>history show</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Displays the current history buffer to standard output.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_namespace">namespace</h3>
<div class="paragraph"><p>Provides namespace-related functions. See also: <a href="http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.6/TclCmd/namespace.htm">http://www.tcl.tk/man/tcl8.6/TclCmd/namespace.htm</a></p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace code</strong> <em>script</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Captures the current namespace context for later execution of
the script <tt><em>script</em></tt>. It returns a new script in which script has
been wrapped in a <tt><strong>namespace inscope</strong></tt> command.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace current</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the fully-qualified name for the current namespace.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace delete</strong> <em>?namespace &#8230;?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Deletes all commands and variables with the given namespace prefixes.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace eval</strong> <em>namespace arg ?arg&#8230;?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Activates a namespace called <tt><em>namespace</em></tt> and evaluates some code in that context.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace origin</strong> <em>command</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the fully-qualified name of the original command to which the imported command <tt><em>command</em></tt> refers.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
+<strong>namespace parent</strong> ?namespace?
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the fully-qualified name of the parent namespace for namespace <tt><em>namespace</em></tt>, if given, otherwise
for the current namespace.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace qualifiers</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns any leading namespace qualifiers for <tt><em>string</em></tt>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace tail</strong> <em>string</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Returns the simple name at the end of a qualified string.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace upvar</strong> <em>namespace ?arg&#8230;?</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This command arranges for zero or more local variables in the current procedure to refer to variables in <tt><em>namespace</em></tt>
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>namespace which</strong> <em>?-command|-variable? name</em></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
Looks up <tt><em>name</em></tt> as either a command (the default) or variable and returns its fully-qualified name.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="BuiltinVariables">BUILT-IN VARIABLES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following global variables are created automatically
by the Tcl library.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>env</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable is set by Jim as an array
whose elements are the environment variables for the process.
Reading an element will return the value of the corresponding
environment variable.
This array is initialised at startup from the <a href="#_env"><strong><tt>env</tt></strong></a> command.
It may be modified and will affect the environment passed to
commands invoked with <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>platform_tcl</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable is set by Jim as an array containing information
about the platform on which Jim was built. Currently this includes
<em>os</em> and <em>platform</em>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>auto_path</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable contains a list of paths to search for packages.
It defaults to a location based on where jim is installed
(e.g. <tt>/usr/local/lib/jim</tt>), but may be changed by <tt>jimsh</tt>
or the embedding application. Note that <tt>jimsh</tt> will consider
the environment variable <tt>$JIMLIB</tt> to be a list of colon-separated
list of paths to add to <tt><strong>auto_path</strong></tt>.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>errorCode</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable holds the value of the -errorcode return
option set by the most recent error that occurred in this
interpreter. This list value represents additional information
about the error in a form that is easy to process with
programs. The first element of the list identifies a general
class of errors, and determines the format of the rest of
the list. The following formats for -errorcode return options
are used by the Tcl core; individual applications may define
additional formats. Currently only <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> sets this variable.
Otherwise it will be <tt>NONE</tt>.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
<div class="paragraph"><p>The following global variables are set by jimsh.</p></div>
<div class="dlist"><dl>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tcl_interactive</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable is set to 1 if jimsh is started in interactive mode
or 0 otherwise.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>tcl_platform</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
This variable is set by Jim as an array containing information
about the platform upon which Jim was built. The following is an
example of the contents of this array.
</p>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>tcl_platform(byteOrder) = littleEndian
tcl_platform(os) = Darwin
tcl_platform(platform) = unix
tcl_platform(pointerSize) = 8
tcl_platform(threaded) = 0
tcl_platform(wordSize) = 8
tcl_platform(pathSeparator) = :</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>argv0</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If jimsh is invoked to run a script, this variable contains the name
of the script.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>argv</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If jimsh is invoked to run a script, this variable contains a list
of any arguments supplied to the script.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>argc</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
If jimsh is invoked to run a script, this variable contains the number
of arguments supplied to the script.
</p>
</dd>
<dt class="hdlist1">
<tt><strong>jim_argv0</strong></tt>
</dt>
<dd>
<p>
The value of argv[0] when jimsh was invoked.
</p>
</dd>
</dl></div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_changes_in_previous_releases">CHANGES IN PREVIOUS RELEASES</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_in_v0_63">In v0.63</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_source"><strong><tt>source</tt></strong></a> now checks that a script is complete (.i.e. not missing a brace)
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<em>info complete</em> now uses the real parser and so is 100% accurate
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Better access to live stack frames with <em>info frame</em>, <a href="#_stacktrace"><strong><tt>stacktrace</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_stackdump"><strong><tt>stackdump</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_tailcall"><strong><tt>tailcall</tt></strong></a> no longer loses stack trace information
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_curry"><strong><tt>curry</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_lambda"><strong><tt>lambda</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_alias"><strong><tt>alias</tt></strong></a> and <a href="#_curry"><strong><tt>curry</tt></strong></a> are implemented via <a href="#_tailcall"><strong><tt>tailcall</tt></strong></a> for efficiency
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_local"><strong><tt>local</tt></strong></a> allows procedures to be deleted automatically at the end of the current procedure
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
udp sockets are now supported for both clients and servers.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
vfork-based exec is now working correctly
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>file tempfile</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>socket pipe</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Enhance <em>try &#8230; on &#8230; finally</em> to be more Tcl 8.6 compatible
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
It is now possible to <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a> from within <a href="#_try"><strong><tt>try</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
IPv6 support is now included
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>string is</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Event handlers works better if an error occurs. eof handler has been removed.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> now sets $::errorCode, and catch sets opts(-errorcode) for exit status
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Command pipelines via open "|&#8230;" are now supported
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_pid"><strong><tt>pid</tt></strong></a> can now return pids of a command pipeline
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>info references</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for <em>after <tt>'ms</em></tt><em>, 'after idle</em>, <em>after info</em>, <a href="#cmd_2"><strong><tt>update</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
<a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> now sets environment based on $::env
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>dict keys</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for <em>lsort -index</em>
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
<div class="sect2">
<h3 id="_in_v0_62">In v0.62</h3>
<div class="olist arabic"><ol class="arabic">
<li>
<p>
Add support to <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> for <em>&gt;&amp;</em>, <em>&gt;&gt;&amp;</em>, <em>|&amp;</em>, <em>2&gt;@1</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Fix <a href="#_exec"><strong><tt>exec</tt></strong></a> error messages when special token (e.g. <em>&gt;</em>) is the last token
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Fix <a href="#_subst"><strong><tt>subst</tt></strong></a> handling of backslash escapes.
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Allow abbreviated options for <a href="#_subst"><strong><tt>subst</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for <a href="#_return"><strong><tt>return</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_break"><strong><tt>break</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_continue"><strong><tt>continue</tt></strong></a> in subst
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Many <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a> bug fixes
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for functions in <a href="#_expr"><strong><tt>expr</tt></strong></a> (e.g. int(), abs()), and also <em>in</em>, <em>ni</em> list operations
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
The variable name argument to <a href="#_regsub"><strong><tt>regsub</tt></strong></a> is now optional
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for <em>unset -nocomplain</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add support for list commands: <a href="#_lassign"><strong><tt>lassign</tt></strong></a>, <a href="#_lrepeat"><strong><tt>lrepeat</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Fully-functional <a href="#_lsearch"><strong><tt>lsearch</tt></strong></a> is now implemented
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>info nameofexecutable</em> and <em>info returncodes</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Allow <a href="#_catch"><strong><tt>catch</tt></strong></a> to determine what return codes are caught
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Allow <a href="#_incr"><strong><tt>incr</tt></strong></a> to increment an unset variable by first setting to 0
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Allow <em>args</em> and optional arguments to the left or required arguments in <a href="#_proc"><strong><tt>proc</tt></strong></a>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>file copy</em>
</p>
</li>
<li>
<p>
Add <em>try &#8230; finally</em> command
</p>
</li>
</ol></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div class="sect1">
<h2 id="_licence">LICENCE</h2>
<div class="sectionbody">
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>Copyright 2005 Salvatore Sanfilippo &lt;antirez@invece.org&gt;
Copyright 2005 Clemens Hintze &lt;c.hintze@gmx.net&gt;
Copyright 2005 patthoyts - Pat Thoyts &lt;patthoyts@users.sf.net&gt;
Copyright 2008 oharboe - Oyvind Harboe - oyvind.harboe@zylin.com
Copyright 2008 Andrew Lunn &lt;andrew@lunn.ch&gt;
Copyright 2008 Duane Ellis &lt;openocd@duaneellis.com&gt;
Copyright 2008 Uwe Klein &lt;uklein@klein-messgeraete.de&gt;
Copyright 2009 Steve Bennett &lt;steveb@workware.net.au&gt;</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE JIM TCL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
JIM TCL PROJECT OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
<div class="literalblock">
<div class="content">
<pre><tt>The views and conclusions contained in the software and documentation
are those of the authors and should not be interpreted as representing
official policies, either expressed or implied, of the Jim Tcl Project.</tt></pre>
</div></div>
</div>
</div>
</div>
<div id="footnotes"><hr /></div>
<div id="footer">
<div id="footer-text">
Last updated 2011-12-14 07:33:13 EST
</div>
</div>
</body>
</html>